]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blob - gcc/doc/tm.texi.in
Merge in trunk.
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi.in
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
3 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5 @node Target Macros
6 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
7 @cindex machine description macros
8 @cindex target description macros
9 @cindex macros, target description
10 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
11
12 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
13 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
14 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
15 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
16 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
17 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
18 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
19 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
20 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
21 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
22 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
23 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
24 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
25
26 @menu
27 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
28 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
29 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
30 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
31 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
32 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
33 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
34 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
35 * Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
36 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
37 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
38 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
39 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
40 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
41 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
42 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
43 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
44 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
45 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
46 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
47 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
48 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
49 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
50 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
51 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
52 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
53 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
54 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
55 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
56 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
57 * Misc:: Everything else.
58 @end menu
59
60 @node Target Structure
61 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
62 @cindex target hooks
63 @cindex target functions
64
65 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
66 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
67 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
68 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
69 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
70 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
71 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
72 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
73 @smallexample
74 #include "target.h"
75 #include "target-def.h"
76
77 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
78
79 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
80 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
81
82 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
83 @end smallexample
84 @end deftypevar
85
86 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
87 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
88 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
89 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
90 @code{targetm} structure.
91
92 Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
93 specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
94 Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
95 initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
96 @file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
97 themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
98 @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
99
100 Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
101 are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
102 documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
103 @file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
104 @code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
105 @file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
106 @code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
107 @code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
108 default definition is used.
109
110 @node Driver
111 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
112 @cindex driver
113 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
114
115 @c prevent bad page break with this line
116 You can control the compilation driver.
117
118 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
119 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
120 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
121
122 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
123 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
124 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
125 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
126 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
127 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
128
129 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
130 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
131 that the other specs are easier to write.
132
133 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
134 @end defmac
135
136 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
137 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
138 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
139 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
140 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
141
142 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
143 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
144 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
145 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
146 everywhere it occurs.
147
148 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
149 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
150 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
151
152 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
153 @end defmac
154
155 @defmac CPP_SPEC
156 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
157 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
158 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
159
160 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
161 @end defmac
162
163 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
164 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
165 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
166 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
167 @end defmac
168
169 @defmac CC1_SPEC
170 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
171 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
172 front ends.
173 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
174 for GCC to pass to front ends.
175
176 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
177 @end defmac
178
179 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
180 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
181 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
182 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
183
184 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
185 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
186 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
187 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
188 @end defmac
189
190 @defmac ASM_SPEC
191 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
192 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
193 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
194 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
195
196 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
197 @end defmac
198
199 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
200 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
201 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
202 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
203 an example of this.
204
205 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
206 @end defmac
207
208 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
209 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
210 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
211 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
212 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
213 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
214
215 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
216 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
217 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
218 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
219 @end defmac
220
221 @defmac LINK_SPEC
222 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
223 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
224 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
225
226 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
227 @end defmac
228
229 @defmac LIB_SPEC
230 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
231 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
232 command given to the linker.
233
234 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
235 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
236 @end defmac
237
238 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
239 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
240 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
241 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
242 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
243
244 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
245 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
246 @end defmac
247
248 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
249 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
250 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
251 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
252 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
253 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
254 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
255 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
256 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
257 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
258 @end defmac
259
260 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
261 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
262 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
263 generated that uses @option{--as-needed} or equivalent options and the
264 shared @file{libgcc} in place of the
265 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
266 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
267 @end defmac
268
269 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
270 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
271 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
272 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
273 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
274 @end defmac
275
276 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
277 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
278 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
279 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
280
281 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
282 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
283 @end defmac
284
285 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
286 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
287 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
288 the very end of the command given to the linker.
289
290 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
291 @end defmac
292
293 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
294 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
295 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
296 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
297 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
298 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
299 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
300 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
301 @end defmac
302
303 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
304 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
305 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
306 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
307 @end defmac
308
309 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
310 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
311 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
312 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
313 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
314 @end defmac
315
316 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
317 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
318 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
319 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
320
321 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
322 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
323 string constant that provides the specification.
324
325 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
326
327 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
328 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
329 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
330 these definitions.
331
332 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
333 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
334 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
335 used.
336
337 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
338
339 @smallexample
340 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
341 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
342
343 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
344 @end smallexample
345
346 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
347 @smallexample
348 #undef CPP_SPEC
349 #define CPP_SPEC \
350 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
351 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
352 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
353 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
354
355 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
356 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
357 @end smallexample
358
359 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
360 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
361
362 @smallexample
363 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
364 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
365 @end smallexample
366 @end defmac
367
368 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
369 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
370 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
371 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
372 @end defmac
373
374 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
375 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
376 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
377 @end defmac
378
379 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
380 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
381 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
382 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
383 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
384 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
385 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
386 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
387 @end defmac
388
389 @hook TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
390
391 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
392 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
393 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
394 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
395 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
396
397 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
398 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
399 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
400 @xref{Target Fragment}.
401 @end defmac
402
403 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
404 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
405 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
406 indicates an absolute file name.
407 @end defmac
408
409 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
410 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
411 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
412 when the compiler is built as a cross
413 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
414 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
415 @end defmac
416
417 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
418 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
419 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
420 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
421 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
422 is built as a cross compiler.
423 @end defmac
424
425 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
426 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
427 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
428 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
429 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
430 is built as a cross compiler.
431 @end defmac
432
433 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
434 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
435 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
436 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
437 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
438 is built as a cross compiler.
439 @end defmac
440
441 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
442 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
443 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
444 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
445 @end defmac
446
447 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
448 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
449 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
450 cross compiler.
451 @end defmac
452
453 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
454 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
455 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
456 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
457 initialize the necessary environment variables.
458 @end defmac
459
460 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
461 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
462 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
463 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
464 comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
465 @file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
466
467 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
468 replacement.
469 @end defmac
470
471 @defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
472 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
473 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
474 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
475 @end defmac
476
477 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
478 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
479 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
480 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
481 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
482 @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
483 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
484 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
485 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
486
487 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
488 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
489 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
490 for C++-only directories,
491 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
492 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
493 the array with a null element.
494
495 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
496 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
497 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
498 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
499
500 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
501
502 @smallexample
503 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
504 @{ \
505 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
506 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
507 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
508 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
509 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
510 @}
511 @end smallexample
512 @end defmac
513
514 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
515
516 @enumerate
517 @item
518 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
519
520 @item
521 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
522 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
523 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
524
525 @item
526 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
527
528 @item
529 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
530 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
531
532 @item
533 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
534
535 @item
536 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
537
538 @item
539 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
540 compiler.
541 @end enumerate
542
543 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
544
545 @enumerate
546 @item
547 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
548
549 @item
550 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
551 value based on the installed toolchain location.
552
553 @item
554 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
555 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
556
557 @item
558 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
559 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
560
561 @item
562 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
563
564 @item
565 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
566 compiler.
567
568 @item
569 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
570 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
571
572 @item
573 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
574 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
575
576 @item
577 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
578 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
579 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
580
581 @item
582 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
583 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
584 @file{/lib/}.
585
586 @item
587 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
588 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
589 @file{/usr/lib/}.
590 @end enumerate
591
592 @node Run-time Target
593 @section Run-time Target Specification
594 @cindex run-time target specification
595 @cindex predefined macros
596 @cindex target specifications
597
598 @c prevent bad page break with this line
599 Here are run-time target specifications.
600
601 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
602 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
603 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
604 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
605 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
606 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
607 finished command line option processing your code can use those
608 results freely.
609
610 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
611 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
612 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
613 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
614
615 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
616 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
617 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
618 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
619 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
620 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
621 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
622 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
623 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
624 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
625
626 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
627 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
628 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
629 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
630 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
631 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
632 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
633 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
634 preprocessing.
635 @end defmac
636
637 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
638 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
639 and is used for the target operating system instead.
640 @end defmac
641
642 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
643 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
644 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
645 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
646 it yourself.
647 @end defmac
648
649 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
650 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
651 any target-specific headers.
652 @end deftypevar
653
654 @hook TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
655 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
656 Its default setting is 0.
657 @end deftypevr
658
659 @cindex optional hardware or system features
660 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
661
662 @hook TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
663 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
664 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
665 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
666 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
667 definition does nothing but return true.
668
669 @var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
670 @var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
671 storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
672 option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
673 via attributes).
674 @end deftypefn
675
676 @hook TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION
677 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
678 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
679 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
680 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
681 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
682 default definition does nothing but return false.
683
684 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
685 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
686 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
687 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
688 @end deftypefn
689
690 @hook TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT
691
692 @hook TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE
693
694 @hook TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION
695
696 @hook TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P
697
698 @hook TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG
699
700 @hook TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE
701
702 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
703 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
704 but is only used in the C
705 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
706 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
707 frontends.
708 @end defmac
709
710 @hook TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
711 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
712 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
713 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
714 options are processed once
715 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
716 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
717 options passed explicitly.
718
719 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
720 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
721 @code{optimize} attribute.
722 @end deftypevr
723
724 @hook TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT
725
726 @hook TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS
727
728 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
729 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
730 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
731 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
732 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
733 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
734
735 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
736 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
737 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
738 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
739 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
740 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
741 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
742
743 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
744 is 0.
745 @end defmac
746
747 @hook TARGET_FLOAT_EXCEPTIONS_ROUNDING_SUPPORTED_P
748
749 @node Per-Function Data
750 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
751 @cindex per-function data
752 @cindex data structures
753
754 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
755 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
756 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
757 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
758 when another one comes along.
759
760 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
761 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
762 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
763 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
764 to their own specific data.
765
766 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
767 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
768 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
769 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
770
771 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
772 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
773 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
774 function, for level 0.
775
776 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
777 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
778 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
779 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
780 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
781 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
782 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
783 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
784 longer supported.
785
786 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
787 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
788 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
789 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
790 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
791 @end defmac
792
793 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
794 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
795 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
796 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
797 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
798 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
799
800 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
801 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
802 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
803 @end deftypevar
804
805 @node Storage Layout
806 @section Storage Layout
807 @cindex storage layout
808
809 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
810 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
811 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
812 @xref{Run-time Target}.
813
814 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
815 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
816 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
817 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
818 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
819 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
820 macro need not be a constant.
821
822 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
823 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
824 @end defmac
825
826 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
827 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
828 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
829 @end defmac
830
831 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
832 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
833 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
834 memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
835 order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
836 macro need not be a constant.
837 @end defmac
838
839 @defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
840 On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
841 registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
842 the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
843 the order of words in memory.
844 @end defmac
845
846 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
847 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
848 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
849 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
850 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
851
852 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
853 multi-word integers.
854 @end defmac
855
856 @defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
857 Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
858 unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
859 @end defmac
860
861 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
862 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
863 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
864 @end defmac
865
866 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
867 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
868 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
869 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
870 @end defmac
871
872 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
873 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
874 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
875 @end defmac
876
877 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
878 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
879 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
880 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
881 @end defmac
882
883 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
884 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
885 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
886 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
887 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
888 @end defmac
889
890 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
891 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
892 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
893 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
894 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
895 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
896 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
897
898 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
899 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
900 @end defmac
901
902 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
903 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
904 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
905 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
906 scalar type.
907
908 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
909 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
910 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
911 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
912 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
913 counterparts.
914
915 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
916 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
917 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
918 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
919 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
920 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
921
922 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
923 @end defmac
924
925 @hook TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
926
927 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
928 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
929 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
930 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
931 size of an integer.
932 @end defmac
933
934 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
935 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
936 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
937 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
938 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
939 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
940 @end defmac
941
942 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
943 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
944 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
945 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
946 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
947 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
948 @end defmac
949
950 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
951 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
952 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
953 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
954 @end defmac
955
956 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
957 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
958 @end defmac
959
960 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
961 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
962 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
963 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
964 @end defmac
965
966 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
967 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
968 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
969 @end defmac
970
971 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
972 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
973 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
974 @end defmac
975
976 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
977 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
978 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
979 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
980 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
981 @end defmac
982
983 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
984 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
985 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
986 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
987 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
988 @end defmac
989
990 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
991 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
992 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
993 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
994 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
995 field alignment has not been set by the
996 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
997 @end defmac
998
999 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1000 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1001 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1002
1003 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1004
1005 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1006 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1007 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1008 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1009 @end defmac
1010
1011 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1012 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1013 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1014 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1015 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1016
1017 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1018 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1019 a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1020 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1021 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1022 @end defmac
1023
1024 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1025 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1026 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1027 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1028 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1029
1030 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1031
1032 @findex strcpy
1033 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1034 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1035 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1036 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1037 @end defmac
1038
1039 @defmac DATA_ABI_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1040 Similar to @code{DATA_ALIGNMENT}, but for the cases where the ABI mandates
1041 some alignment increase, instead of optimization only purposes. E.g.@
1042 AMD x86-64 psABI says that variables with array type larger than 15 bytes
1043 must be aligned to 16 byte boundaries.
1044
1045 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1046 @end defmac
1047
1048 @defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1049 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1050 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1051 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1052 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1053 align the object.
1054
1055 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1056
1057 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1058 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1059 constants can be done inline.
1060 @end defmac
1061
1062 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1063 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1064 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1065 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1066 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1067
1068 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1069
1070 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1071 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1072
1073 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1074 @end defmac
1075
1076 @hook TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT
1077
1078 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1079 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1080 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1081 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1082 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1083 align the slot.
1084
1085 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1086 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1087 be used.
1088
1089 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1090 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1091
1092 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1093 @end defmac
1094
1095 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1096 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1097 variable @var{decl}.
1098
1099 If this macro is not defined, then
1100 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1101 is used.
1102
1103 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1104 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1105
1106 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1107 @end defmac
1108
1109 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1110 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1111 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1112 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1113
1114 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1115 @end defmac
1116
1117 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1118 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1119 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1120
1121 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1122 @end defmac
1123
1124 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1125 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1126 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1127
1128 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1129 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1130 @end defmac
1131
1132 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1133 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1134 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1135 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1136 @end defmac
1137
1138 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1139 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1140 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1141
1142 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1143 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1144 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1145 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1146 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1147
1148 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1149 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1150 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1151 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1152
1153 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1154 structure.
1155
1156 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1157 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1158
1159 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1160 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1161 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1162 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1163
1164 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1165 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1166 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1167
1168 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1169 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1170 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1171
1172 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1173 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1174 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1175
1176 @smallexample
1177 struct foo1
1178 @{
1179 char x;
1180 char :0;
1181 char y;
1182 @};
1183
1184 struct foo2
1185 @{
1186 char x;
1187 int :0;
1188 char y;
1189 @};
1190
1191 main ()
1192 @{
1193 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1194 sizeof (struct foo1));
1195 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1196 sizeof (struct foo2));
1197 exit (0);
1198 @}
1199 @end smallexample
1200
1201 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1202 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1203 @end defmac
1204
1205 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1206 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1207 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1208 @end defmac
1209
1210 @hook TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD
1211
1212 @hook TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD
1213
1214 @hook TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK
1215
1216 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1217 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1218 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1219 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1220 @var{specified}.
1221
1222 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1223 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1224 @end defmac
1225
1226 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1227 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1228 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1229 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1230 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1231 (DImode)} is assumed.
1232 @end defmac
1233
1234 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1235 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1236 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1237 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1238 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1239 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1240 having its mode specified.
1241
1242 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1243 would most commonly define this macro if the
1244 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1245 64-bit mode.
1246 @end defmac
1247
1248 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1249 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1250 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1251 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1252
1253 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1254 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1255 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1256 @end defmac
1257
1258 @hook TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE
1259
1260 @hook TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE
1261
1262 @hook TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE
1263
1264 @defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1265 If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1266 mode is towards zero.
1267
1268 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1269 floating-point arithmetic.
1270
1271 Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1272 @end defmac
1273
1274 @defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1275 This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1276 bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1277 exponent for normal numbers instead.
1278
1279 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1280 floating-point arithmetic.
1281
1282 The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1283 @end defmac
1284
1285 @hook TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P
1286
1287 @hook TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P
1288
1289 @hook TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P
1290
1291 @hook TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK
1292
1293 @hook TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS
1294
1295 @hook TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE
1296
1297 @node Type Layout
1298 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1299
1300 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1301 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1302 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1303 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1304
1305 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1306 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1307 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1308 @end defmac
1309
1310 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1311 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1312 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1313 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1314 unit.)
1315 @end defmac
1316
1317 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1318 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1319 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1320 @end defmac
1321
1322 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1323 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1324 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1325 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1326 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1327 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1328 @end defmac
1329
1330 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1331 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1332 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1333 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1334 macro must be at least 64.
1335 @end defmac
1336
1337 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1338 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1339 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1340 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1341 @end defmac
1342
1343 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1344 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1345 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1346 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1347 @end defmac
1348
1349 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1350 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1351 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1352 @end defmac
1353
1354 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1355 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1356 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1357 words.
1358 @end defmac
1359
1360 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1361 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1362 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1363 words.
1364 @end defmac
1365
1366 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1367 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1368 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1369 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1370 @end defmac
1371
1372 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1373 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1374 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1375 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1376 @end defmac
1377
1378 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1379 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1380 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1381 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1382 @end defmac
1383
1384 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1385 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1386 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1387 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1388 @end defmac
1389
1390 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1391 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1392 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1393 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1394 @end defmac
1395
1396 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1397 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1398 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1399 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1400 @end defmac
1401
1402 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1403 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1404 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1405 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1406 @end defmac
1407
1408 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1409 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1410 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1411 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1412 @end defmac
1413
1414 @defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1415 Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1416 if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1417 @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1418 default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1419 @end defmac
1420
1421 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
1422 Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
1423 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1424 @code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1425 anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1426 or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1427 otherwise it is 0.
1428 @end defmac
1429
1430 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1431 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1432 @code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1433 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1434 is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1435 @end defmac
1436
1437 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1438 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1439 @code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1440 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1441 is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1442 @end defmac
1443
1444 @defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1445 This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1446 hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1447 causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1448 prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1449 uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1450 the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1451 @end defmac
1452
1453 @defmac SF_SIZE
1454 @defmacx DF_SIZE
1455 @defmacx XF_SIZE
1456 @defmacx TF_SIZE
1457 Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1458 @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1459 if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1460 @code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1461 for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1462 @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
1463 @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
1464 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1465 @end defmac
1466
1467 @defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1468 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1469 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1470 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1471 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1472 @end defmac
1473
1474 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1475 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1476 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1477 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1478 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1479 is the default.
1480 @end defmac
1481
1482 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1483 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1484 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1485 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1486 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1487 @end defmac
1488
1489 @hook TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1490
1491 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1492 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1493 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1494 contents of the string.
1495
1496 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1497 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1498 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1499 of the data type names defined in the function
1500 @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1501 You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1502 compiler to crash on startup.
1503
1504 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1505 int"}.
1506 @end defmac
1507
1508 @defmac SIZETYPE
1509 GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1510 @code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1511 dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1512 the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1513 is extracted.
1514
1515 The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1516
1517 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1518 @end defmac
1519
1520 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1521 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1522 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1523 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1524 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1525
1526 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1527 @end defmac
1528
1529 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1530 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1531 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1532 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1533 information.
1534
1535 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1536 @end defmac
1537
1538 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1539 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1540 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1541 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1542 @end defmac
1543
1544 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1545 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1546 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1547 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1548 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1549 information.
1550
1551 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1552 @end defmac
1553
1554 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1555 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1556 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1557 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1558 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1559
1560 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1561 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1562 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1563 @end defmac
1564
1565 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1566 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1567 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1568 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1569 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1570
1571 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1572 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1573 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1574 int}.
1575 @end defmac
1576
1577 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1578 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1579 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1580 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1581 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1582 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1583 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1584 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1585 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1586 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1587 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1588 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1589 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1590 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1591 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1592 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1593 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1594 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1595 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1596 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1597 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1598 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1599 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1600 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1601 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1602 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1603 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1604 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1605 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1606 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1607 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1608 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1609 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1610 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1611 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1612 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1613 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1614
1615 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1616 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1617 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1618 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1619 these macros are null pointers.
1620 @end defmac
1621
1622 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1623 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1624 that looks like:
1625
1626 @smallexample
1627 struct @{
1628 union @{
1629 void (*fn)();
1630 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1631 @};
1632 ptrdiff_t delta;
1633 @};
1634 @end smallexample
1635
1636 @noindent
1637 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1638 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1639 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1640 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1641 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1642 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1643 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1644 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1645
1646 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1647 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1648 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1649 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1650 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1651 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1652 architecture, you should define this macro to
1653 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1654
1655 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1656 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1657 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1658 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1659 @end defmac
1660
1661 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1662 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1663 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1664 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1665 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1666 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1667 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1668
1669 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1670 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1671 @end defmac
1672
1673 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1674 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1675 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1676 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1677 when special alignment is necessary. */
1678 @end defmac
1679
1680 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1681 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1682 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1683 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1684 of words in each data entry.
1685 @end defmac
1686
1687 @node Registers
1688 @section Register Usage
1689 @cindex register usage
1690
1691 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1692 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1693
1694 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1695 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1696 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1697 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1698 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1699
1700 @menu
1701 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1702 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1703 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1704 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1705 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1706 @end menu
1707
1708 @node Register Basics
1709 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1710
1711 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1712 Registers have various characteristics.
1713
1714 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1715 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1716 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1717 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1718 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1719 @end defmac
1720
1721 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1722 @cindex fixed register
1723 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1724 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1725 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1726 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1727 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1728 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1729 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1730
1731 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1732 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1733 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1734
1735 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1736 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1737 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1738 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1739 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1740 @end defmac
1741
1742 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1743 @cindex call-used register
1744 @cindex call-clobbered register
1745 @cindex call-saved register
1746 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1747 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1748 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1749 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1750 function calls.
1751
1752 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1753 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1754 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1755 @end defmac
1756
1757 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1758 @cindex call-used register
1759 @cindex call-clobbered register
1760 @cindex call-saved register
1761 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1762 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1763 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1764 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1765 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1766 @end defmac
1767
1768 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1769 @cindex call-used register
1770 @cindex call-clobbered register
1771 @cindex call-saved register
1772 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1773 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1774 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1775 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1776 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1777 @end defmac
1778
1779 @findex fixed_regs
1780 @findex call_used_regs
1781 @findex global_regs
1782 @findex reg_names
1783 @findex reg_class_contents
1784 @hook TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1785
1786 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1787 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1788 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1789 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1790 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1791 outbound register.
1792 @end defmac
1793
1794 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1795 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1796 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1797 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1798 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1799 register.
1800 @end defmac
1801
1802 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1803 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1804 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1805 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1806 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1807 gotos.
1808 @end defmac
1809
1810 @defmac PC_REGNUM
1811 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1812 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1813 @end defmac
1814
1815 @node Allocation Order
1816 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1817 @cindex order of register allocation
1818 @cindex register allocation order
1819
1820 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1821 Registers are allocated in order.
1822
1823 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1824 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1825 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1826 to use them (from most preferred to least).
1827
1828 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1829 (all else being equal).
1830
1831 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1832 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1833 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1834 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1835 the highest numbered allocable register first.
1836 @end defmac
1837
1838 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1839 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1840 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1841
1842 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1843 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1844 register; and so on.
1845
1846 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1847 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1848
1849 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
1850 @end defmac
1851
1852 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1853 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
1854 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
1855 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
1856 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
1857 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
1858 should be defined.
1859 @end defmac
1860
1861 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
1862 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
1863 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
1864 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
1865 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
1866 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
1867 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
1868 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
1869
1870 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
1871 @end defmac
1872
1873 @node Values in Registers
1874 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
1875
1876 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
1877 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
1878 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
1879
1880 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1881 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
1882 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
1883 @var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
1884 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
1885 and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
1886
1887 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
1888 definition of this macro is
1889
1890 @smallexample
1891 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
1892 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
1893 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
1894 @end smallexample
1895 @end defmac
1896
1897 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1898 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
1899 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
1900 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
1901 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
1902 this mode by the number of registers returned by
1903 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
1904
1905 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
1906 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
1907 nonzero.
1908
1909 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
1910 @code{subreg_get_info}
1911 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
1912 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
1913 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
1914 registers and so not be representable.
1915 @end defmac
1916
1917 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1918 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
1919 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
1920 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
1921 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
1922 @end defmac
1923
1924 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
1925 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
1926 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
1927 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
1928 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
1929 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
1930 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
1931 @end defmac
1932
1933 @defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1934 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
1935 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
1936 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
1937 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
1938
1939 @smallexample
1940 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
1941 @end smallexample
1942
1943 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
1944 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
1945
1946 @cindex register pairs
1947 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
1948 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
1949 odd register numbers for such modes.
1950
1951 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
1952 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
1953 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
1954 value into the register and back out not alter it.
1955
1956 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
1957 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
1958 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
1959 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
1960 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
1961 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
1962 to be tieable.
1963
1964 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
1965 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
1966 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
1967 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
1968 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
1969 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
1970
1971 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
1972 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
1973 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
1974 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
1975 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
1976 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
1977 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
1978 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
1979 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
1980
1981 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
1982 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
1983 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
1984 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
1985 constraints for those instructions.
1986
1987 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
1988 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
1989 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
1990 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
1991 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
1992 @end defmac
1993
1994 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
1995 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
1996 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
1997
1998 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
1999 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2000 handler.
2001
2002 The default is always nonzero.
2003 @end defmac
2004
2005 @defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2006 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2007 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2008
2009 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2010 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2011 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2012 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2013 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2014 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2015
2016 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2017 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2018 allocation.
2019 @end defmac
2020
2021 @hook TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK
2022
2023 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2024 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2025 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2026 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2027 @end defmac
2028
2029 @node Leaf Functions
2030 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2031
2032 @cindex leaf functions
2033 @cindex functions, leaf
2034 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2035 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2036 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2037 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2038 normally arrive.
2039
2040 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2041 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2042 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2043 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2044 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2045 functions''.
2046
2047 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2048 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2049 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2050 accomplish this.
2051
2052 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2053 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2054 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2055 function treatment.
2056
2057 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2058 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2059 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2060 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2061 in this vector.
2062
2063 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2064 the treatment of leaf functions.
2065 @end defmac
2066
2067 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2068 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2069 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2070
2071 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2072 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2073 will cause the compiler to abort.
2074
2075 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2076 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2077 this.
2078 @end defmac
2079
2080 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2081 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2082 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2083 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2084 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2085 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2086 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2087 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2088 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2089 functions which only use leaf registers.
2090 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2091 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2092 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2093 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2094 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2095
2096 @node Stack Registers
2097 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2098
2099 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2100 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2101 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2102 stack.
2103
2104 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2105 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2106 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2107 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2108 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2109 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2110 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2111
2112 @defmac STACK_REGS
2113 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2114 @end defmac
2115
2116 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2117 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2118 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2119 @end defmac
2120
2121 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2122 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2123 of the stack.
2124 @end defmac
2125
2126 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2127 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2128 the stack.
2129 @end defmac
2130
2131 @node Register Classes
2132 @section Register Classes
2133 @cindex register class definitions
2134 @cindex class definitions, register
2135
2136 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2137 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2138 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2139 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2140
2141 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2142 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2143 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2144
2145 @findex ALL_REGS
2146 @findex NO_REGS
2147 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2148 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2149 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2150 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2151
2152 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2153 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2154 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2155 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2156 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2157 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2158
2159 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2160 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2161
2162 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2163 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2164 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2165 them in operand constraints.
2166
2167 You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2168 registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2169 some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2170 cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2171 (@pxref{Costs}).
2172
2173 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2174 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2175 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2176 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2177 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2178 or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2179 class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2180
2181 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2182 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2183 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2184 in their union.
2185
2186 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2187 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2188 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2189 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2190 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2191
2192 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2193 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2194 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2195 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2196 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2197 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2198 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2199 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2200 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2201
2202 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2203 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2204 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2205 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2206 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2207 tells how many classes there are.
2208
2209 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2210 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2211 in many of the tables described below.
2212 @end deftp
2213
2214 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2215 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2216
2217 @smallexample
2218 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2219 @end smallexample
2220 @end defmac
2221
2222 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2223 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2224 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2225 @end defmac
2226
2227 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2228 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2229 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2230 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2231 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2232
2233 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2234 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2235 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2236 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2237 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2238 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2239 so on.
2240 @end defmac
2241
2242 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2243 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2244 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2245 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2246 register.
2247 @end defmac
2248
2249 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2250 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2251 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2252 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2253 @end defmac
2254
2255 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2256 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2257 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2258 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2259 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2260 @end defmac
2261
2262 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2263 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2264 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2265 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2266 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2267 @end defmac
2268
2269 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2270 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2271 base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2272 space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2273 define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2274 the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2275 of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2276 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2277 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2278 @end defmac
2279
2280 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2281 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2282 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2283 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2284 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2285 @end defmac
2286
2287 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2288 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2289 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2290 @end defmac
2291
2292 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2293 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2294 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2295 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2296 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2297 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2298 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2299 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2300 @code{address_operand}.
2301 @end defmac
2302
2303 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2304 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2305 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2306 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2307 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2308 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2309 than other base register uses.
2310
2311 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2312 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2313 @end defmac
2314
2315 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2316 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2317 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2318 memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2319 This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2320 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2321 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2322 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2323 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2324 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2325 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2326 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2327 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2328 @end defmac
2329
2330 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2331 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2332 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2333 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2334 allocated such a hard register.
2335
2336 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2337 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2338 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2339 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2340 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2341 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2342 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2343 only if neither labeling works.
2344 @end defmac
2345
2346 @hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS
2347
2348 @hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2349
2350 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2351 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2352 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2353 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2354 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2355 safe:
2356
2357 @smallexample
2358 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2359 @end smallexample
2360
2361 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2362 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2363 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2364 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2365 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2366
2367 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2368 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2369 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2370 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2371 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2372 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2373 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2374 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2375 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2376 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2377 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2378
2379 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2380 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2381 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2382 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2383 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2384 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2385 @end defmac
2386
2387 @hook TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2388
2389 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2390 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2391 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2392 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2393 ordinarily be used.
2394
2395 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2396 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2397
2398 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2399 smaller class.
2400
2401 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2402 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2403 @end defmac
2404
2405 @hook TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
2406
2407 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2408 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2409 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2410 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2411 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2412
2413 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2414 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2415 reload phase that it may
2416 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2417 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2418 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2419 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2420 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2421 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2422
2423 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2424 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2425 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2426 class required. If the
2427 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2428 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2429 macros identically.
2430
2431 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2432 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2433 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2434 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2435 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2436
2437 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2438 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2439 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2440 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2441 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2442 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2443 register.
2444
2445 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2446 register that
2447 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2448 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2449 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2450 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2451 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2452
2453 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2454 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2455 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2456 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2457
2458 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2459 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2460 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2461 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2462 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2463 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2464 general registers.
2465 @end defmac
2466
2467 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2468 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2469 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2470 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2471 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2472 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2473 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2474
2475 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2476 @end defmac
2477
2478 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2479 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2480 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2481 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2482 defined by this macro.
2483
2484 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2485 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2486 @end defmac
2487
2488 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2489 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2490 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2491 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2492 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2493 same as that of @var{mode}.
2494
2495 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2496 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2497 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2498 registers.
2499
2500 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2501 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2502 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2503 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2504 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2505 details.
2506
2507 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2508 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2509 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2510 @end defmac
2511
2512 @hook TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2513
2514 @hook TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS
2515
2516 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2517 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2518 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2519
2520 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2521 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2522 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2523 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2524
2525 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2526 in the reload pass.
2527 @end defmac
2528
2529 @defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2530 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2531 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2532
2533 For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2534 floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2535 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2536 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2537 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2538 as below:
2539
2540 @smallexample
2541 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2542 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2543 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2544 @end smallexample
2545 @end defmac
2546
2547 @hook TARGET_LRA_P
2548
2549 @hook TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY
2550
2551 @hook TARGET_REGISTER_USAGE_LEVELING_P
2552
2553 @hook TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P
2554
2555 @hook TARGET_SPILL_CLASS
2556
2557 @hook TARGET_CSTORE_MODE
2558
2559 @node Old Constraints
2560 @section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2561 @cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2562 @cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2563
2564 Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2565 of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2566 Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2567 it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2568
2569 @defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2570 For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2571 @var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2572 constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2573 you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2574 constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2575 DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2576 to handle specially.
2577 There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2578 for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2579 transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2580 return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2581 will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2582 @end defmac
2583
2584 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2585 A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2586 letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2587 value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2588 the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2589 corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2590 to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2591 @end defmac
2592
2593 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2594 Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2595 passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2596 different variants.
2597 @end defmac
2598
2599 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2600 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2601 letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2602 particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2603 letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2604 the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2605 not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2606 @var{value}.
2607 @end defmac
2608
2609 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2610 Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2611 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2612 between different variants.
2613 @end defmac
2614
2615 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2616 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2617 letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2618 (@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2619
2620 If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2621 @var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2622 range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2623 letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2624
2625 @code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2626 @code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2627 or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2628 between these kinds.
2629 @end defmac
2630
2631 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2632 Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2633 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2634 between different variants.
2635 @end defmac
2636
2637 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2638 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2639 letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2640 memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2641 elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2642 @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2643 may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2644
2645 If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2646 if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2647 constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2648 constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2649
2650 For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2651 in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2652 letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2653 @emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2654 a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2655 alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2656 does not include r0 on the output.
2657 @end defmac
2658
2659 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2660 Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2661 in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2662 variants.
2663 @end defmac
2664
2665 @defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2666 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2667 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2668 be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2669
2670 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2671 at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
2672 comprises a subset of all memory references including
2673 all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
2674 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2675 type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
2676
2677 For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
2678 memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
2679 register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
2680 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
2681 If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
2682 a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
2683 reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
2684 into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
2685 an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
2686 @end defmac
2687
2688 @defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2689 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2690 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
2691 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
2692 be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
2693
2694 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2695 at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
2696 a subset of all memory addresses including
2697 all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
2698 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2699 type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
2700
2701 Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
2702 be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
2703 analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
2704 @end defmac
2705
2706 @node Stack and Calling
2707 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2708 @cindex calling conventions
2709
2710 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2711 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2712
2713 @menu
2714 * Frame Layout::
2715 * Exception Handling::
2716 * Stack Checking::
2717 * Frame Registers::
2718 * Elimination::
2719 * Stack Arguments::
2720 * Register Arguments::
2721 * Scalar Return::
2722 * Aggregate Return::
2723 * Caller Saves::
2724 * Function Entry::
2725 * Profiling::
2726 * Tail Calls::
2727 * Stack Smashing Protection::
2728 @end menu
2729
2730 @node Frame Layout
2731 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
2732 @cindex stack frame layout
2733 @cindex frame layout
2734
2735 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2736 Here is the basic stack layout.
2737
2738 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2739 Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2740 pointer to a smaller address.
2741
2742 When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
2743 compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
2744 definition used does not matter.
2745 @end defmac
2746
2747 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
2748 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2749 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
2750 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
2751
2752 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2753 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
2754 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2755 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2756 space for the next item on the stack.
2757
2758 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
2759 defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
2760 which is often wrong.
2761 @end defmac
2762
2763 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2764 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
2765 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
2766 @end defmac
2767
2768 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2769 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2770 addresses on the stack.
2771 @end defmac
2772
2773 @defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2774 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
2775
2776 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
2777 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2778 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
2779 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2780 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
2781 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
2782 @end defmac
2783
2784 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
2785 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
2786 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
2787
2788 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
2789 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
2790 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
2791 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
2792 @end defmac
2793
2794 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2795 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
2796 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
2797 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
2798
2799 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2800 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
2801 @end defmac
2802
2803 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2804 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
2805 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
2806 function.
2807
2808 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2809 the first argument's address.
2810 @end defmac
2811
2812 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2813 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
2814 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
2815
2816 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
2817 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
2818 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
2819 @end defmac
2820
2821 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
2822 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
2823 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
2824 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
2825 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
2826 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
2827 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
2828 @end defmac
2829
2830 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
2831 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
2832 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
2833 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
2834 itself.
2835
2836 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
2837 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
2838 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
2839 @end defmac
2840
2841 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
2842 If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
2843 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
2844 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
2845 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
2846 define this macro.
2847 @end defmac
2848
2849 @hook TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
2850
2851 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
2852 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
2853 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
2854 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
2855 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
2856 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
2857 @end defmac
2858
2859 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
2860 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
2861 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
2862 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
2863 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
2864 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
2865
2866 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
2867 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
2868 determine the return address of other frames.
2869 @end defmac
2870
2871 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
2872 Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
2873 from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
2874 @end defmac
2875
2876 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2877 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
2878 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
2879 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
2880 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
2881 the stack.
2882
2883 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
2884 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
2885
2886 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
2887 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
2888 @end defmac
2889
2890 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
2891 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
2892 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
2893 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
2894 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
2895
2896 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
2897 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
2898 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
2899 over time.
2900 @end defmac
2901
2902 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
2903 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
2904 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
2905 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
2906 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
2907 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
2908 @end defmac
2909
2910 @hook TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC
2911
2912 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
2913 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
2914 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
2915 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
2916 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
2917 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
2918
2919 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
2920 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
2921 @end defmac
2922
2923 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2924 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
2925 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
2926 final value should coincide with that calculated by
2927 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
2928 during virtual register instantiation.
2929
2930 The default value for this macro is
2931 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
2932 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
2933 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
2934 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
2935 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
2936
2937 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
2938 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
2939 DWARF 2.
2940 @end defmac
2941
2942 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2943 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
2944 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
2945 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
2946 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
2947
2948 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
2949 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
2950 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
2951 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
2952 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
2953 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
2954 should be defined.
2955 @end defmac
2956
2957 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2958 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
2959 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
2960 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
2961 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
2962 @end defmac
2963
2964 @node Exception Handling
2965 @subsection Exception Handling Support
2966 @cindex exception handling
2967
2968 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
2969 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
2970 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
2971 @var{N} registers are usable.
2972
2973 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
2974 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
2975 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
2976 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
2977 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
2978
2979 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
2980 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
2981 @end defmac
2982
2983 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
2984 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
2985 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
2986 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
2987 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
2988
2989 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
2990 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
2991
2992 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
2993 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
2994 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
2995 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
2996 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
2997 that provided by DWARF 2.
2998 @end defmac
2999
3000 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3001 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3002 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3003 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3004
3005 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3006 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3007 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3008 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3009 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3010 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3011 target call frame.
3012
3013 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3014 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3015 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3016
3017 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3018 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3019 @end defmac
3020
3021 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3022 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3023 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3024 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3025 using it to return to the exception handler.
3026 @end defmac
3027
3028 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3029 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3030 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3031 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3032 and so may be read-only.
3033
3034 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3035 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3036 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3037 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3038
3039 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3040 represented directly.
3041 @end defmac
3042
3043 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3044 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3045 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3046 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3047 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3048
3049 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3050 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3051 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3052 to be emitted.
3053 @end defmac
3054
3055 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3056 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3057 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3058 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3059 through signal frames.
3060
3061 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3062 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3063 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3064 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3065 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3066 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3067 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3068 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3069 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3070
3071 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3072 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3073 @end defmac
3074
3075 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3076 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3077 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3078 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3079
3080 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3081 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3082 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3083 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3084 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3085 be updated in @var{fs}.
3086 @end defmac
3087
3088 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3089 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3090 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3091 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3092 @end defmac
3093
3094 @node Stack Checking
3095 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3096
3097 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3098 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3099 three ways:
3100
3101 @enumerate
3102 @item
3103 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3104 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3105 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3106 other special processing.
3107
3108 @item
3109 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3110 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3111 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3112 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3113 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3114 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3115 approach below.
3116
3117 @item
3118 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3119 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3120 @end enumerate
3121
3122 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3123 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3124 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3125 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3126
3127 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3128 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3129 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3130 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3131 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3132 value of this macro is zero.
3133 @end defmac
3134
3135 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3136 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3137 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3138 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3139 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3140 @end defmac
3141
3142 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3143 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3144 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3145 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3146 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3147 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3148 @end defmac
3149
3150 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3151 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3152 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3153 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3154 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3155 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3156 default value of this macro is zero.
3157 @end defmac
3158
3159 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3160 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3161 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3162 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3163 8192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3164 most machines.
3165 @end defmac
3166
3167 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3168 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3169 in the opposite case.
3170
3171 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3172 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3173 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3174 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3175 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3176 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3177 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3178 @end defmac
3179
3180 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3181 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3182 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3183 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3184 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3185 use the default of four words.
3186 @end defmac
3187
3188 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3189 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3190 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3191 @option{-fstack-check}.
3192 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3193 normally not need to override that default.
3194 @end defmac
3195
3196 @need 2000
3197 @node Frame Registers
3198 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3199
3200 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3201 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3202
3203 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3204 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3205 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3206 the hardware determines which register this is.
3207 @end defmac
3208
3209 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3210 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3211 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3212 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3213 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3214 @end defmac
3215
3216 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3217 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3218 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3219 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3220 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3221 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3222 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3223 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3224 used for the frame pointer.
3225
3226 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3227 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3228 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3229 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3230 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3231 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3232 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3233
3234 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3235 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3236 @end defmac
3237
3238 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3239 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3240 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3241 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3242 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3243 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3244 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3245 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3246 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3247 @end defmac
3248
3249 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3250 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3251 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3252 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3253 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3254 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3255 @end defmac
3256
3257 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3258 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3259 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3260 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3261 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3262 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3263 @end defmac
3264
3265 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3266 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3267 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3268 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3269 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3270 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3271 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3272
3273 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3274 address from the stack.
3275 @end defmac
3276
3277 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3278 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3279 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3280 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3281 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3282 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3283 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3284 not be defined.
3285
3286 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3287
3288 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3289 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3290 @end defmac
3291
3292 @hook TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN
3293
3294 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3295 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3296 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3297 DWARF2 exception handling.
3298
3299 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3300 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3301 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3302 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3303 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3304 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3305 registers that are not call-saved.
3306
3307 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3308 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3309 @end defmac
3310
3311 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3312
3313 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3314 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3315
3316 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3317 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3318 @end defmac
3319
3320 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3321
3322 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3323 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3324 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3325 column number to use instead.
3326
3327 See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3328 @end defmac
3329
3330 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3331
3332 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3333 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3334 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3335 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3336 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3337
3338 @end defmac
3339
3340 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3341
3342 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3343 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3344 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3345 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3346 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3347
3348 @end defmac
3349
3350 @defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3351
3352 Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3353 @code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3354 target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3355 default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3356
3357 @end defmac
3358
3359 @defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3360
3361 Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3362 context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3363 it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3364 defined and 0 otherwise.
3365
3366 @end defmac
3367
3368 @node Elimination
3369 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3370
3371 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3372 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3373
3374 @hook TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3375
3376 @findex get_frame_size
3377 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3378 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3379 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3380 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3381 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3382 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3383
3384 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3385 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3386 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3387 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3388 @end defmac
3389
3390 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3391 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3392 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3393 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3394 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3395
3396 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3397 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3398
3399 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3400 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3401 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3402 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3403 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3404
3405 In this case, you might specify:
3406 @smallexample
3407 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3408 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3409 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3410 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3411 @end smallexample
3412
3413 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3414 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3415 @end defmac
3416
3417 @hook TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
3418
3419 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3420 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3421 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3422 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3423 defined.
3424 @end defmac
3425
3426 @node Stack Arguments
3427 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3428 @cindex arguments on stack
3429 @cindex stack arguments
3430
3431 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3432 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3433 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3434
3435 @hook TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3436
3437 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3438 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3439 outgoing arguments.
3440 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3441 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3442 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3443 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3444 @end defmac
3445
3446 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3447 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3448 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3449 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3450 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3451 @end defmac
3452
3453 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3454 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3455 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3456
3457 On some machines, the definition
3458
3459 @smallexample
3460 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3461 @end smallexample
3462
3463 @noindent
3464 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3465 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3466 alignment. Then the definition should be
3467
3468 @smallexample
3469 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3470 @end smallexample
3471
3472 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3473 @end defmac
3474
3475 @findex outgoing_args_size
3476 @findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
3477 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3478 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3479 will be computed and placed into
3480 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3481 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3482 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3483
3484 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3485 is not proper.
3486 @end defmac
3487
3488 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3489 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3490 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3491 registers.
3492
3493 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3494 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3495 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3496 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3497 of the function.
3498
3499 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3500 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3501 which.
3502 @end defmac
3503 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3504 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3505
3506 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3507 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3508 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3509 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3510 if the function called is a library function.
3511
3512 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3513 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3514 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
3515 @end defmac
3516
3517 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3518 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3519 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3520 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3521 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3522
3523 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3524 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3525 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3526 stack in its natural location.
3527 @end defmac
3528
3529 @hook TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS
3530
3531 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3532 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3533 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3534 when compiling a function call.
3535
3536 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3537 have been accumulated.
3538
3539 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3540 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3541 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3542 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3543 appropriate.
3544 @end defmac
3545
3546 @node Register Arguments
3547 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3548 @cindex arguments in registers
3549 @cindex registers arguments
3550
3551 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3552 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3553 the stack.
3554
3555 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG
3556
3557 @hook TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
3558
3559 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
3560
3561 @hook TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
3562
3563 @hook TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
3564
3565 @hook TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
3566
3567 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3568 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
3569 of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
3570 target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
3571 of bytes of argument so far.
3572
3573 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
3574 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
3575 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
3576 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
3577 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
3578 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
3579 @end defmac
3580
3581 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
3582 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
3583 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
3584 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
3585 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
3586 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
3587 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
3588 @end defmac
3589
3590 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
3591 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
3592 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
3593 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
3594 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
3595 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
3596 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
3597 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
3598 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
3599 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
3600 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
3601 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
3602 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
3603
3604 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
3605 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
3606 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
3607 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
3608 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
3609 never both of them at once.
3610 @end defmac
3611
3612 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
3613 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
3614 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
3615 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
3616 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
3617 0)} is used instead.
3618 @end defmac
3619
3620 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
3621 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
3622 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
3623 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
3624
3625 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
3626 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
3627 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
3628 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
3629 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
3630 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
3631 @end defmac
3632
3633 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
3634
3635 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3636 If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
3637 offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
3638 which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
3639 slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
3640 top.
3641 @end defmac
3642
3643 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3644 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
3645 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
3646 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
3647 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
3648
3649 The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
3650 target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
3651 always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
3652
3653 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
3654 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
3655 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
3656 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
3657 @end defmac
3658
3659 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
3660 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
3661 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
3662 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
3663 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
3664 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
3665 @end defmac
3666
3667 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
3668 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
3669 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
3670 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
3671 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
3672 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
3673 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
3674 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
3675 required.
3676 @end defmac
3677
3678 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
3679
3680 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY
3681
3682 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
3683 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
3684 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
3685 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
3686 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
3687 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
3688 stack.
3689 @end defmac
3690
3691 @hook TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG
3692
3693 @hook TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
3694
3695 @hook TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P
3696
3697 @hook TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST
3698
3699 @hook TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST_BOUNDS_SIZE
3700
3701 @hook TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE
3702
3703 @hook TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
3704
3705 @hook TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
3706
3707 @hook TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO
3708
3709 @hook TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
3710
3711 @hook TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
3712
3713 @hook TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
3714
3715 @hook TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P
3716
3717 @hook TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
3718
3719 @node Scalar Return
3720 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
3721 @cindex return values in registers
3722 @cindex values, returned by functions
3723 @cindex scalars, returned as values
3724
3725 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
3726 values---values that can fit in registers.
3727
3728 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
3729
3730 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
3731 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
3732 a new target instead.
3733 @end defmac
3734
3735 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
3736 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
3737 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
3738
3739 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
3740 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
3741 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
3742 compiled.
3743 @end defmac
3744
3745 @hook TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
3746
3747 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
3748 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
3749 register in which the values of called function may come back.
3750
3751 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
3752 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
3753 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
3754 suffices:
3755
3756 @smallexample
3757 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
3758 @end smallexample
3759
3760 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
3761 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
3762 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
3763
3764 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
3765 for a new target instead.
3766 @end defmac
3767
3768 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
3769
3770 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
3771 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
3772 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
3773 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
3774 @end defmac
3775
3776 @hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
3777
3778 @node Aggregate Return
3779 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
3780 @cindex aggregates as return values
3781 @cindex large return values
3782 @cindex returning aggregate values
3783 @cindex structure value address
3784
3785 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
3786 cases), the value is not returned according to
3787 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
3788 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
3789 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
3790 address}.
3791
3792 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
3793 memory.
3794
3795 @hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
3796
3797 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
3798 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
3799 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
3800 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
3801 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
3802 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
3803 target hook.
3804
3805 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
3806 @end defmac
3807
3808 @hook TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
3809
3810 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
3811 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
3812 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
3813 the address of a static variable containing the value.
3814
3815 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
3816 pass an address to the subroutine.
3817
3818 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
3819 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
3820 @end defmac
3821
3822 @hook TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE
3823
3824 @hook TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE
3825
3826 @node Caller Saves
3827 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
3828
3829 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
3830 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
3831 must live across calls.
3832
3833 @defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
3834 A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
3835 a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
3836 restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
3837 this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
3838
3839 If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
3840 machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
3841 @end defmac
3842
3843 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
3844 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
3845 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
3846 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
3847 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
3848 will select the smallest suitable mode.
3849 @end defmac
3850
3851 @node Function Entry
3852 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
3853 @cindex function entry and exit
3854 @cindex prologue
3855 @cindex epilogue
3856
3857 This section describes the macros that output function entry
3858 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
3859
3860 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
3861
3862 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
3863
3864 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE
3865
3866 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
3867
3868 @itemize @bullet
3869 @item
3870 @findex pretend_args_size
3871 @findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
3872 A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
3873 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
3874 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
3875 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
3876 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
3877 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
3878 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
3879 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
3880 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
3881
3882 @item
3883 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
3884 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
3885 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
3886 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
3887 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
3888 a save area.
3889
3890 @item
3891 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
3892 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
3893 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
3894 save area closer to the top of the stack.
3895
3896 @item
3897 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
3898 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
3899 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
3900 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
3901 @end itemize
3902
3903 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
3904 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
3905 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
3906 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
3907 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
3908 default is 0.
3909
3910 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
3911 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
3912 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
3913 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
3914 @end defmac
3915
3916 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
3917 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
3918 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
3919 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
3920 @end defmac
3921
3922 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
3923 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
3924 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
3925 on entry to an exception edge.
3926 @end defmac
3927
3928 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
3929
3930 @hook TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
3931
3932 @node Profiling
3933 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
3934 @cindex profiling, code generation
3935
3936 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
3937
3938 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
3939 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
3940 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
3941
3942 @findex mcount
3943 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
3944 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
3945 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
3946 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
3947
3948 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
3949 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
3950 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
3951 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
3952 @end defmac
3953
3954 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
3955 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
3956 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
3957 not support profiling.
3958 @end defmac
3959
3960 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
3961 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
3962 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
3963 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
3964 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
3965 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
3966 @end defmac
3967
3968 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
3969 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
3970 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
3971 @end defmac
3972
3973 @node Tail Calls
3974 @subsection Permitting tail calls
3975 @cindex tail calls
3976
3977 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
3978
3979 @hook TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY
3980
3981 @hook TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE
3982
3983 @hook TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN
3984
3985 @node Stack Smashing Protection
3986 @subsection Stack smashing protection
3987 @cindex stack smashing protection
3988
3989 @hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD
3990
3991 @hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL
3992
3993 @hook TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK
3994
3995 @node Varargs
3996 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
3997 @cindex varargs implementation
3998
3999 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4000 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4001 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4002 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4003 conditionals to include it.
4004
4005 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4006 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4007 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4008 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4009 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4010 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4011
4012 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4013 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4014 below.
4015
4016 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4017 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4018 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4019 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4020 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4021
4022 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4023 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4024 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4025 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4026
4027 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4028 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4029 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4030 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4031 to use them for its own purposes.
4032 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4033 @c 10feb93
4034 @end defmac
4035
4036 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
4037 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
4038 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4039 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4040 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4041 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4042 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4043 of the current function.
4044 @end defmac
4045
4046 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4047 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4048 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4049 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4050 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4051 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4052
4053 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4054 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4055 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4056
4057 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4058 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4059 @end defmac
4060
4061 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4062
4063 @hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
4064
4065 @hook TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
4066
4067 @hook TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
4068
4069 @hook TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
4070
4071 @hook TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG
4072
4073 @hook TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG
4074
4075 @node Trampolines
4076 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
4077 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
4078 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
4079
4080 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
4081 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
4082 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
4083 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
4084 trampoline.
4085
4086 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
4087 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
4088 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
4089 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
4090 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
4091 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
4092 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
4093 operands.
4094
4095 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
4096 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
4097 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
4098 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
4099 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
4100 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
4101 separately.
4102
4103 @hook TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
4104
4105 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
4106 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
4107 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
4108 @end defmac
4109
4110 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
4111 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
4112 @end defmac
4113
4114 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
4115 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
4116
4117 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
4118 is used for aligning trampolines.
4119 @end defmac
4120
4121 @hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
4122
4123 @hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
4124
4125 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
4126 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
4127 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
4128 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
4129
4130 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
4131 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
4132 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
4133 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
4134 latter makes initialization faster.
4135
4136 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
4137 the following macro.
4138
4139 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
4140 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
4141 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
4142 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
4143 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
4144 @end defmac
4145
4146 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
4147 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
4148 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
4149 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
4150 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
4151
4152 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
4153 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
4154 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
4155 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
4156 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
4157
4158 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
4159 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
4160 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
4161 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
4162 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
4163 special assembler code.
4164 @end defmac
4165
4166 @node Library Calls
4167 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
4168 @cindex library subroutine names
4169 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
4170
4171 @c prevent bad page break with this line
4172 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
4173
4174 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
4175 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
4176 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
4177 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
4178 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
4179 @end defmac
4180
4181 @findex set_optab_libfunc
4182 @findex init_one_libfunc
4183 @hook TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
4184
4185 @hook TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
4186
4187 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
4188 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
4189 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
4190 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
4191 return a tristate.
4192
4193 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
4194 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
4195 don't need to define this macro.
4196 @end defmac
4197
4198 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
4199 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
4200 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
4201 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
4202 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
4203 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
4204 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
4205 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
4206 @end defmac
4207
4208 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
4209 @findex matherr
4210 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
4211 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
4212 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
4213 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
4214 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
4215 system.
4216
4217 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
4218 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
4219 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
4220 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
4221 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
4222 @end defmac
4223
4224 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
4225 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
4226 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
4227 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
4228 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
4229 macro, a reasonable default is used.
4230 @end defmac
4231
4232 @hook TARGET_LIBC_HAS_FUNCTION
4233
4234 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
4235 Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
4236 by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
4237 and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
4238 This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
4239 the NeXT runtime installed.
4240
4241 If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
4242 will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
4243 selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
4244
4245 In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
4246 scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
4247 @end defmac
4248
4249 @node Addressing Modes
4250 @section Addressing Modes
4251 @cindex addressing modes
4252
4253 @c prevent bad page break with this line
4254 This is about addressing modes.
4255
4256 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
4257 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
4258 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
4259 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
4260 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
4261 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
4262 @end defmac
4263
4264 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
4265 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
4266 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
4267 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
4268 the size of the memory operand.
4269 @end defmac
4270
4271 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
4272 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
4273 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
4274 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
4275 @end defmac
4276
4277 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
4278 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
4279 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
4280 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
4281 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
4282 constant addresses are supported.
4283 @end defmac
4284
4285 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
4286 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
4287 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
4288 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
4289 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
4290 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
4291 @end defmac
4292
4293 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
4294 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
4295 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
4296 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
4297 accept.
4298 @end defmac
4299
4300 @hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
4301
4302 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
4303 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
4304 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
4305 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
4306 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
4307 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
4308 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
4309 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
4310 @code{'m'} constraint.
4311 @end defmac
4312
4313 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
4314 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
4315 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
4316 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
4317 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
4318
4319 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
4320 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
4321
4322 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
4323 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
4324 @end defmac
4325
4326 @hook TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
4327
4328 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
4329 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
4330 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
4331 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
4332 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
4333 performance reasons.
4334
4335 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
4336 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
4337 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
4338 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
4339 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
4340 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
4341 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
4342 be shared.
4343
4344 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
4345 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
4346 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
4347 of reload internals.
4348
4349 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
4350 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
4351 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
4352
4353 @findex push_reload
4354 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
4355 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
4356 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
4357
4358 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
4359 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
4360 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
4361 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
4362 @code{push_reload}.
4363
4364 @findex strict_memory_address_p
4365 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
4366 the address has become legitimate.
4367
4368 @findex copy_rtx
4369 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
4370 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
4371 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
4372 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
4373 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
4374 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
4375 @end defmac
4376
4377 @hook TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P
4378
4379 @hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
4380
4381 @hook TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
4382
4383 @hook TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P
4384
4385 @hook TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
4386
4387 @hook TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P
4388
4389 @hook TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_DECL_P
4390
4391 @hook TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL
4392
4393 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD
4394
4395 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST
4396
4397 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE
4398
4399 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK
4400
4401 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION
4402
4403 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION
4404
4405 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT
4406
4407 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE
4408
4409 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES
4410
4411 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST
4412
4413 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST
4414
4415 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST
4416
4417 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA
4418
4419 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_LOAD
4420
4421 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_STORE
4422
4423 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER
4424
4425 @node Anchored Addresses
4426 @section Anchored Addresses
4427 @cindex anchored addresses
4428 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
4429
4430 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
4431 For example, if we have:
4432
4433 @smallexample
4434 static int a, b, c;
4435 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
4436 @end smallexample
4437
4438 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
4439 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
4440 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
4441 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
4442 be something like:
4443
4444 @smallexample
4445 int foo (void)
4446 @{
4447 register int *xr = &x;
4448 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
4449 @}
4450 @end smallexample
4451
4452 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
4453 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
4454
4455 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
4456 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
4457 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
4458 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
4459
4460 @hook TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
4461
4462 @hook TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
4463
4464 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR
4465
4466 @hook TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P
4467
4468 @node Condition Code
4469 @section Condition Code Status
4470 @cindex condition code status
4471
4472 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
4473 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
4474
4475 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
4476 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
4477 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
4478 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
4479 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
4480 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
4481 most RISC machines.
4482
4483 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
4484 the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
4485 insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
4486 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
4487 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
4488 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
4489 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
4490 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
4491
4492 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
4493 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
4494 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
4495 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
4496 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
4497 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
4498 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
4499
4500 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
4501 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
4502 interested in most macros in this section.
4503
4504 @menu
4505 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
4506 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
4507 @end menu
4508
4509 @node CC0 Condition Codes
4510 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
4511 @findex cc0
4512
4513 @findex cc_status
4514 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
4515 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
4516 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
4517 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
4518 currently based, and several standard flags.
4519
4520 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
4521 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
4522 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
4523
4524 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
4525 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
4526 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
4527
4528 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
4529 @end defmac
4530
4531 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
4532 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
4533 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
4534 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
4535 define this macro to initialize it.
4536
4537 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
4538 @end defmac
4539
4540 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
4541 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
4542 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
4543 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
4544 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
4545 set @code{(cc0)}.
4546
4547 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
4548
4549 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
4550 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
4551 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
4552 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
4553 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
4554 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
4555 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
4556 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
4557 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
4558 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
4559 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
4560 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
4561 condition code value.
4562
4563 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
4564 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
4565 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
4566 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
4567 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
4568 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
4569 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
4570
4571 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
4572 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
4573 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
4574 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
4575 @end defmac
4576
4577 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
4578 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
4579 @findex CCmode
4580 @findex MODE_CC
4581
4582 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
4583 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
4584 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
4585 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
4586 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
4587 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
4588 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
4589 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
4590 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
4591 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
4592 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
4593
4594 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
4595 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
4596 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
4597 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
4598 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
4599 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
4600 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
4601
4602 @smallexample
4603 (define_insn ""
4604 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
4605 (compare:CC_NOOV
4606 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
4607 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
4608 (const_int 0)))]
4609 ""
4610 "@dots{}")
4611 @end smallexample
4612
4613 @noindent
4614 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
4615 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
4616
4617 @smallexample
4618 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
4619 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
4620 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
4621 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
4622 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
4623 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
4624 @end smallexample
4625
4626 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
4627 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
4628 this section.
4629
4630 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
4631 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
4632 @end defmac
4633
4634 @hook TARGET_CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON
4635
4636 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
4637 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
4638 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
4639 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
4640 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
4641
4642 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
4643 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
4644 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
4645 inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
4646
4647 @smallexample
4648 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
4649 @end smallexample
4650 @end defmac
4651
4652 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
4653 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
4654 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
4655 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
4656 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
4657 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
4658 freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
4659 like:
4660
4661 @smallexample
4662 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
4663 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
4664 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
4665 @end smallexample
4666 @end defmac
4667
4668 @hook TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS
4669
4670 @hook TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE
4671
4672 @node Costs
4673 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
4674 @cindex costs of instructions
4675 @cindex relative costs
4676 @cindex speed of instructions
4677
4678 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
4679 on the target machine.
4680
4681 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
4682 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
4683 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
4684 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
4685 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
4686 that.
4687
4688 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
4689 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
4690 registers if they are not general registers.
4691
4692 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
4693 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
4694 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
4695 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
4696 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
4697 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
4698
4699 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
4700 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
4701 @end defmac
4702
4703 @hook TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
4704
4705 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
4706 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
4707 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
4708 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
4709 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
4710 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
4711 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
4712
4713 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
4714 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
4715 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
4716 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
4717 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
4718 reflect the actual cost of the move.
4719
4720 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
4721 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
4722 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
4723 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
4724 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
4725 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
4726 are the same as to this macro.
4727
4728 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
4729 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
4730 @end defmac
4731
4732 @hook TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
4733
4734 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
4735 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
4736 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
4737 @var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
4738 for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
4739 optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
4740 true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
4741 @code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
4742 @end defmac
4743
4744 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
4745 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
4746 ordinarily expect.
4747
4748 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
4749 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
4750 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
4751 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
4752 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
4753 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
4754
4755 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
4756 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
4757 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
4758 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
4759 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
4760 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
4761 @end defmac
4762
4763 @defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
4764 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
4765 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
4766 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
4767 handler.
4768
4769 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
4770 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
4771 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
4772 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
4773 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
4774
4775 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
4776 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
4777 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
4778 @end defmac
4779
4780 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
4781 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
4782 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
4783 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
4784 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
4785
4786 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
4787 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
4788 the number of such sequences.
4789
4790 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
4791 optimized for speed rather than size.
4792
4793 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
4794 @end defmac
4795
4796 @defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
4797 A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
4798 copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
4799 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
4800 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
4801 @end defmac
4802
4803 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
4804 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
4805 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
4806 @end defmac
4807
4808 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
4809 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
4810 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
4811 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
4812 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
4813
4814 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
4815 optimized for speed rather than size.
4816
4817 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
4818 @end defmac
4819
4820 @defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
4821 A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
4822 to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
4823 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
4824 than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
4825 @end defmac
4826
4827 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
4828 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
4829 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
4830 a block set insn or a library call.
4831 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
4832 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
4833
4834 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
4835 optimized for speed rather than size.
4836
4837 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
4838 @end defmac
4839
4840 @defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
4841 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
4842 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
4843 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
4844 storing values other than constant zero.
4845 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
4846 than @code{SET_RATIO}.
4847 @end defmac
4848
4849 @defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
4850 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
4851 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
4852 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
4853 called with a constant source string.
4854 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
4855 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
4856 @end defmac
4857
4858 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
4859 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
4860 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
4861 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
4862 @end defmac
4863
4864 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
4865 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
4866 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
4867 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
4868 @end defmac
4869
4870 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
4871 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
4872 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
4873 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
4874 @end defmac
4875
4876 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
4877 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
4878 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
4879 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
4880 @end defmac
4881
4882 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
4883 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
4884 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
4885 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
4886 @end defmac
4887
4888 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
4889 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
4890 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
4891 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
4892 @end defmac
4893
4894 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
4895 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
4896 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
4897 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
4898 @end defmac
4899
4900 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
4901 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
4902 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
4903 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
4904 @end defmac
4905
4906 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
4907 Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
4908 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
4909 @end defmac
4910
4911 @defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
4912 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
4913 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
4914 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
4915 @end defmac
4916
4917 @hook TARGET_RTX_COSTS
4918
4919 @hook TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
4920
4921 @node Scheduling
4922 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
4923
4924 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
4925 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
4926 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
4927 them: try the first ones in this list first.
4928
4929 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
4930
4931 @hook TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
4932
4933 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
4934
4935 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY
4936
4937 @hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER
4938
4939 @hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2
4940
4941 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK
4942
4943 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT
4944
4945 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH
4946
4947 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL
4948
4949 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL
4950
4951 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
4952
4953 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
4954
4955 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
4956
4957 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
4958
4959 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE
4960
4961 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE
4962
4963 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
4964
4965 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD
4966
4967 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN
4968
4969 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE
4970
4971 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK
4972
4973 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END
4974
4975 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT
4976
4977 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI
4978
4979 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE
4980
4981 @hook TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE
4982
4983 @hook TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED
4984
4985 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT
4986
4987 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT
4988
4989 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT
4990
4991 @hook TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT
4992
4993 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT
4994
4995 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN
4996
4997 @hook TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P
4998
4999 @hook TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK
5000
5001 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC
5002
5003 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS
5004
5005 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII
5006
5007 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH
5008
5009 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO
5010
5011 @hook TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
5012
5013 @hook TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH
5014
5015 @node Sections
5016 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
5017 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
5018 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
5019
5020 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
5021 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
5022 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
5023 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
5024 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
5025 of sections.
5026
5027 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
5028 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
5029 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
5030 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
5031 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
5032 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
5033 They may however depend on command-line flags.
5034
5035 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
5036 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
5037 to be string literals.
5038
5039 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
5040 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
5041 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
5042 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
5043
5044 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
5045 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
5046 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
5047 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
5048 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
5049 reuse @code{text_section}.
5050
5051 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
5052 if the target does not provide them.
5053
5054 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5055 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5056 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
5057 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
5058 @end defmac
5059
5060 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
5061 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
5062 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
5063 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
5064 @end defmac
5065
5066 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
5067 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
5068 executed functions in the program.
5069 @end defmac
5070
5071 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5072 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5073 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
5074 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
5075 @end defmac
5076
5077 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5078 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5079 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5080 initialized, writable small data.
5081 @end defmac
5082
5083 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5084 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5085 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
5086 data.
5087 @end defmac
5088
5089 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5090 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5091 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5092 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
5093 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
5094 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
5095 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
5096 used.
5097 @end defmac
5098
5099 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5100 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5101 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5102 uninitialized, writable small data.
5103 @end defmac
5104
5105 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
5106 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
5107 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
5108 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
5109 @end defmac
5110
5111 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
5112 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
5113 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
5114 default is @code{'T'}.
5115 @end defmac
5116
5117 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5118 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5119 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5120 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
5121 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
5122 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
5123 @end defmac
5124
5125 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
5126 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5127 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5128 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
5129 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
5130 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
5131 @end defmac
5132
5133 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
5134 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5135 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5136 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
5137 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
5138 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
5139 @end defmac
5140
5141 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
5142 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5143 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5144 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
5145 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
5146 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
5147 @end defmac
5148
5149 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
5150 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
5151 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
5152 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
5153 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
5154 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
5155 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
5156 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
5157 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
5158 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
5159 @end defmac
5160
5161 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
5162 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
5163 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
5164 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
5165 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
5166 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
5167 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
5168 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
5169 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
5170 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
5171 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
5172 @end defmac
5173
5174 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
5175 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
5176 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
5177 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
5178 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
5179 @end defmac
5180
5181 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
5182 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
5183 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
5184 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
5185 readonly data section is used.
5186
5187 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
5188 @end defmac
5189
5190 @hook TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS
5191
5192 @hook TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK
5193
5194 @hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION
5195
5196 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
5197 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
5198 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
5199
5200 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
5201 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
5202 it is unlikely to be called.
5203 @end defmac
5204
5205 @hook TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION
5206
5207 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION
5208
5209 @hook TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
5210
5211 @hook TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION
5212
5213 @hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
5214
5215 @hook TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME
5216
5217 @hook TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
5218
5219 @hook TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
5220
5221 @hook TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
5222
5223 @hook TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
5224
5225 @hook TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
5226
5227 @hook TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P
5228
5229 @hook TARGET_HAVE_TLS
5230
5231
5232 @node PIC
5233 @section Position Independent Code
5234 @cindex position independent code
5235 @cindex PIC
5236
5237 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
5238 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
5239 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
5240 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
5241 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
5242 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
5243 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
5244 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
5245 relative addresses.
5246 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
5247 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
5248
5249 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
5250 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
5251 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
5252 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
5253 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
5254 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
5255 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
5256 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
5257 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
5258 @end defmac
5259
5260 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
5261 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
5262 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
5263 the default is zero. Do not define
5264 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
5265 @end defmac
5266
5267 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
5268 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
5269 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
5270 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
5271 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
5272 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
5273 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
5274 position independent code.
5275 @end defmac
5276
5277 @node Assembler Format
5278 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
5279
5280 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
5281 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
5282 instructions do.
5283
5284 @menu
5285 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
5286 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
5287 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
5288 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
5289 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
5290 and termination routines.
5291 * Macros for Initialization::
5292 Specific macros that control the handling of
5293 initialization and termination routines.
5294 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
5295 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
5296 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
5297 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
5298 @end menu
5299
5300 @node File Framework
5301 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
5302 @cindex assembler format
5303 @cindex output of assembler code
5304
5305 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5306 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
5307
5308 @findex default_file_start
5309 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
5310
5311 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
5312
5313 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
5314
5315 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
5316
5317 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
5318 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
5319 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
5320 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
5321 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
5322 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
5323 this function.
5324 @end deftypefun
5325
5326 @hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_START
5327
5328 @hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_END
5329
5330 @hook TARGET_ASM_CODE_END
5331
5332 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
5333 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
5334 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
5335 the end of the line.
5336 @end defmac
5337
5338 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
5339 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
5340 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
5341 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
5342 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
5343 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
5344 @end defmac
5345
5346 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
5347 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
5348 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
5349 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
5350 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
5351 @end defmac
5352
5353 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
5354 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
5355 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
5356 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
5357
5358 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
5359 for the file format in use is appropriate.
5360 @end defmac
5361
5362 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
5363
5364 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT
5365
5366 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
5367 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
5368 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
5369 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
5370 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
5371 of the filename using this macro.
5372 @end defmac
5373
5374 @hook TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
5375
5376 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION
5377
5378 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS
5379
5380 @hook TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
5381 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
5382 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
5383 @end deftypevr
5384
5385 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
5386 @hook TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
5387
5388 @hook TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
5389
5390 @hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES
5391
5392 @hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
5393
5394 @need 2000
5395 @node Data Output
5396 @subsection Output of Data
5397
5398
5399 @hook TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
5400
5401 @hook TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
5402
5403 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
5404
5405 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
5406 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
5407 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
5408 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
5409 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
5410
5411 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
5412 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
5413 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
5414 @end defmac
5415
5416 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
5417 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
5418 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
5419 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
5420 @end defmac
5421
5422 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
5423 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
5424 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
5425 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
5426 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
5427 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
5428 pool before the function.
5429 @end defmac
5430
5431 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
5432 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
5433 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
5434 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
5435 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
5436 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
5437 immediately after this call.
5438
5439 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
5440 not be defined.
5441 @end defmac
5442
5443 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
5444 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
5445 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
5446 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
5447
5448 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
5449 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
5450 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
5451 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
5452 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
5453 alignment.
5454
5455 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
5456 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
5457 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
5458 Here is how to do this:
5459
5460 @smallexample
5461 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
5462 @end smallexample
5463
5464 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
5465 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
5466 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
5467
5468 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
5469 @end defmac
5470
5471 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
5472 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
5473 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
5474 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
5475 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
5476 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
5477
5478 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
5479 define this macro.
5480 @end defmac
5481
5482 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
5483 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
5484 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
5485 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
5486 a line separator uses multiple characters.
5487
5488 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
5489 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
5490 @end defmac
5491
5492 @hook TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
5493
5494 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
5495 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
5496
5497 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
5498 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
5499 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
5500 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
5501 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
5502 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
5503 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
5504 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
5505 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
5506 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
5507 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
5508 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
5509 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
5510 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
5511 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
5512 on the host machine.
5513
5514 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
5515 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
5516 machine's memory.
5517 @end defmac
5518
5519 @node Uninitialized Data
5520 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
5521
5522 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
5523 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
5524
5525 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
5526 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
5527 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
5528 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
5529 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
5530 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
5531 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
5532 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
5533 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
5534 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
5535 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
5536 an ordinary undefined external.
5537
5538 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
5539 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
5540 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
5541
5542 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
5543 common global variables are output.
5544 @end defmac
5545
5546 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
5547 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
5548 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
5549 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
5550 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
5551 as the number of bits.
5552 @end defmac
5553
5554 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
5555 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
5556 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
5557 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
5558 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
5559 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
5560 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
5561 @end defmac
5562
5563 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
5564 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
5565 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
5566 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
5567 is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
5568
5569 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
5570 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
5571 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
5572 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
5573 the name, and a newline.
5574
5575 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
5576 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
5577 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
5578 You do not need to do both.
5579
5580 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
5581 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
5582 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
5583 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
5584 common in order to save space in the object file.
5585 @end defmac
5586
5587 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
5588 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
5589 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
5590 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
5591 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
5592
5593 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
5594 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
5595 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
5596
5597 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
5598 static variables are output.
5599 @end defmac
5600
5601 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
5602 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
5603 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
5604 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
5605 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
5606 as the number of bits.
5607 @end defmac
5608
5609 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
5610 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
5611 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
5612 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
5613 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
5614 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
5615 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
5616 @end defmac
5617
5618 @node Label Output
5619 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
5620
5621 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5622 This is about outputting labels.
5623
5624 @findex assemble_name
5625 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
5626 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
5627 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
5628 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
5629 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
5630 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
5631 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
5632 @end defmac
5633
5634 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
5635 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
5636 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
5637 a function.
5638 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
5639 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
5640 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
5641 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
5642
5643 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
5644 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
5645 @end defmac
5646
5647 @findex assemble_name_raw
5648 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
5649 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
5650 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
5651 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
5652 that it is more efficient.
5653 @end defmac
5654
5655 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
5656 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
5657 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
5658 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
5659 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
5660
5661 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
5662 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
5663 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
5664 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
5665 define this macro.
5666 @end defmac
5667
5668 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
5669 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
5670 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
5671 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
5672 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
5673 provided.
5674 @end defmac
5675
5676 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
5677 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
5678 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
5679 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
5680 address.
5681
5682 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
5683 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
5684 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
5685 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
5686 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
5687 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
5688 @end defmac
5689
5690 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
5691 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
5692 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
5693 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
5694 @samp{.} is used instead.
5695 @end defmac
5696
5697 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
5698 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
5699 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
5700 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
5701 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
5702 @end defmac
5703
5704 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
5705 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
5706 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
5707 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
5708 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
5709
5710 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
5711 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
5712 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
5713 types at all, do not define this macro.
5714 @end defmac
5715
5716 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
5717 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
5718 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
5719 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
5720 the default is not to define this macro.
5721
5722 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
5723 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
5724 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
5725 types at all, do not define this macro.
5726 @end defmac
5727
5728 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
5729 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
5730 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
5731 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
5732 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
5733 you should not count on this.
5734
5735 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
5736 definition of this macro is provided.
5737 @end defmac
5738
5739 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
5740 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
5741 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
5742 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
5743 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
5744 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
5745 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
5746
5747 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
5748 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
5749
5750 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
5751 of this macro.
5752 @end defmac
5753
5754 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
5755 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
5756 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
5757 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
5758 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
5759 representing the function.
5760
5761 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
5762
5763 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
5764 of this macro.
5765 @end defmac
5766
5767 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
5768 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
5769 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
5770 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
5771 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
5772 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
5773
5774 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
5775 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
5776
5777 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
5778 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
5779 @end defmac
5780
5781 @hook TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME
5782
5783 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
5784 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
5785 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
5786 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
5787
5788 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
5789 nothing.
5790 @end defmac
5791
5792 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
5793 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
5794 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
5795 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
5796 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
5797 something about the size of the object.
5798
5799 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
5800 nothing.
5801
5802 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
5803 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
5804 @end defmac
5805
5806 @hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
5807
5808 @hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME
5809
5810 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
5811 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
5812 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
5813 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
5814 no other definition is available. Use the expression
5815 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
5816 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
5817 for making that name weak, and a newline.
5818
5819 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
5820 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
5821 macro.
5822 @end defmac
5823
5824 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
5825 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
5826 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
5827 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
5828 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
5829 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
5830 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
5831 to make @var{name} weak.
5832 @end defmac
5833
5834 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
5835 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
5836 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
5837 declaration of @code{name}.
5838 @end defmac
5839
5840 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
5841 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
5842 supports weak symbols.
5843
5844 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
5845 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
5846 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
5847 @end defmac
5848
5849 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
5850 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
5851
5852 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
5853 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
5854 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
5855 flag such as @option{-melf}.
5856 @end defmac
5857
5858 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
5859 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
5860 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
5861 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
5862 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
5863 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
5864 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
5865 @end defmac
5866
5867 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
5868 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
5869 semantics.
5870
5871 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
5872 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
5873 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
5874 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
5875 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
5876 be emitted as one-only.
5877 @end defmac
5878
5879 @hook TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY
5880
5881 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
5882 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
5883 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
5884 The default is @code{0}.
5885
5886 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
5887 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
5888 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
5889 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
5890 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
5891 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
5892 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
5893
5894 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
5895 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
5896 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
5897 table of contents.
5898 @end defmac
5899
5900 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
5901 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
5902 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
5903 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
5904 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
5905 declaration.
5906
5907 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
5908 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
5909 @end defmac
5910
5911 @hook TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
5912
5913 @hook TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED
5914
5915 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
5916 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
5917 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
5918 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
5919 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
5920 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
5921 @end defmac
5922
5923 @hook TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME
5924
5925 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
5926 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
5927 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
5928 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
5929 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
5930 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
5931 @end defmac
5932
5933 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
5934 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
5935 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
5936 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
5937 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
5938 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
5939 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
5940 being taken.
5941 @end defmac
5942
5943 @hook TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL
5944
5945 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
5946 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
5947 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
5948 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
5949 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
5950 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
5951 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
5952 bundles.
5953
5954 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
5955 used.
5956 @end defmac
5957
5958 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
5959 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
5960 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
5961
5962 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
5963 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
5964 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
5965
5966 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
5967 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
5968 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
5969 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
5970 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
5971 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
5972 you should know what it does on your machine.)
5973 @end defmac
5974
5975 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
5976 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
5977 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
5978 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
5979 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
5980
5981 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
5982 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
5983 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
5984 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
5985 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
5986 internal static variables in different scopes.
5987
5988 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
5989 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
5990 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
5991 between the name and the number will suffice.
5992
5993 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
5994 which is correct for most systems.
5995 @end defmac
5996
5997 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
5998 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
5999 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
6000
6001 @findex SET_ASM_OP
6002 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
6003 correct for most systems.
6004 @end defmac
6005
6006 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
6007 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6008 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
6009 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
6010 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
6011 the tree nodes are available.
6012
6013 @findex SET_ASM_OP
6014 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
6015 correct for most systems.
6016 @end defmac
6017
6018 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
6019 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
6020 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
6021 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
6022 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
6023 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
6024 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
6025 @end defmac
6026
6027 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6028 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6029 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
6030 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
6031 an undefined weak symbol.
6032
6033 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
6034 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
6035 @end defmac
6036
6037 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
6038 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
6039 Objective-C methods.
6040
6041 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
6042 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
6043 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
6044 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
6045
6046 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
6047 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
6048 systems define other ways of computing names.
6049
6050 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
6051 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
6052 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
6053 50 characters extra.
6054
6055 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
6056 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
6057 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
6058 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
6059
6060 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
6061 macro to provide more human-readable names.
6062 @end defmac
6063
6064 @node Initialization
6065 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
6066 @cindex initialization routines
6067 @cindex termination routines
6068 @cindex constructors, output of
6069 @cindex destructors, output of
6070
6071 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
6072 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
6073 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
6074 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
6075 @code{main} is called.
6076
6077 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
6078 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
6079 terminates.
6080
6081 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
6082 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
6083 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
6084 system, you need to specify how to do this.
6085
6086 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
6087 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
6088 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
6089
6090 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
6091 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
6092 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
6093 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
6094 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
6095
6096 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
6097 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
6098 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
6099 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
6100 pointer containing zero.
6101
6102 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
6103 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
6104 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
6105 list; destructors in forward order.
6106
6107 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
6108 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
6109 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
6110 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
6111 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
6112 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
6113 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
6114 Termination functions are handled similarly.
6115
6116 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
6117 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
6118 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
6119 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
6120 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
6121
6122 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
6123 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
6124 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
6125 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
6126 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
6127
6128 @smallexample
6129 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
6130 @end smallexample
6131
6132 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
6133 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
6134 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
6135 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
6136 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
6137
6138 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
6139 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
6140 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
6141 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
6142 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
6143 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
6144
6145 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
6146 macro properly.
6147
6148 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
6149 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
6150 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
6151 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
6152 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
6153 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
6154
6155 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
6156 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
6157 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
6158 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
6159 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
6160 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
6161 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
6162 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
6163 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
6164 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
6165 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
6166 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
6167 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
6168 the initialization process.
6169
6170 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
6171 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
6172 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
6173 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
6174 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
6175 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
6176 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
6177 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
6178 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
6179 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
6180 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
6181
6182 @ifinfo
6183 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
6184 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
6185 @end ifinfo
6186
6187 @node Macros for Initialization
6188 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
6189
6190 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
6191 and termination functions:
6192
6193 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6194 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
6195 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
6196 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
6197 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
6198 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
6199 run the initialization functions.
6200 @end defmac
6201
6202 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
6203 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
6204 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
6205 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
6206 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6207 @end defmac
6208
6209 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
6210 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
6211 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
6212 @end defmac
6213
6214 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
6215 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
6216 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
6217 @end defmac
6218
6219 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
6220 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
6221 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
6222 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
6223 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
6224 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
6225
6226 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
6227 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
6228 exception tables embedded in the code.
6229 @end defmac
6230
6231 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
6232 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
6233 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
6234 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
6235 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
6236 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
6237 @end defmac
6238
6239 @defmac INVOKE__main
6240 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
6241 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
6242 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
6243 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
6244 @end defmac
6245
6246 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
6247 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
6248 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
6249 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
6250 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
6251 @end defmac
6252
6253 @hook TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
6254
6255 @hook TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
6256
6257 @hook TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
6258
6259 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
6260 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
6261
6262 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
6263 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
6264 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
6265
6266 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
6267 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
6268
6269 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
6270 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
6271 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
6272 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
6273
6274 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
6275 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
6276 @end defmac
6277
6278 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
6279 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
6280 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
6281 @command{nm}.
6282 @end defmac
6283
6284 @defmac NM_FLAGS
6285 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
6286 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
6287 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
6288 are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
6289 produces.
6290 @end defmac
6291
6292 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
6293 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
6294 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
6295 termination functions in shared libraries:
6296
6297 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
6298 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
6299 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
6300 @end defmac
6301
6302 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
6303 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
6304 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
6305 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
6306 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
6307 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
6308 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
6309 @end defmac
6310
6311 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
6312 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
6313 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
6314 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
6315 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
6316 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
6317 @end defmac
6318
6319 @node Instruction Output
6320 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
6321
6322 @c prevent bad page break with this line
6323 This describes assembler instruction output.
6324
6325 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
6326 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
6327 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
6328 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
6329 @end defmac
6330
6331 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
6332 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
6333 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
6334 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
6335 to registers using alternate names.
6336 @end defmac
6337
6338 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
6339 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
6340 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
6341 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
6342 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
6343 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
6344 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
6345 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
6346
6347 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
6348 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
6349 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
6350 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
6351 ``s0'' and ``s1''.
6352 @end defmac
6353
6354 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
6355 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
6356 requires different names for the machine instructions.
6357
6358 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
6359 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
6360 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
6361 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
6362 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
6363 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
6364 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
6365 so that it will not be output twice.
6366
6367 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
6368 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
6369 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
6370 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
6371 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
6372
6373 @findex recog_data.operand
6374 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
6375 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
6376
6377 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
6378 in the usual way.
6379 @end defmac
6380
6381 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
6382 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
6383 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
6384 they will be output differently.
6385
6386 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
6387 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
6388 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
6389 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
6390 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
6391 by changing the contents of the vector.
6392
6393 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
6394 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
6395 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
6396 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
6397 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
6398 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
6399
6400 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
6401 @end defmac
6402
6403 @hook TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN
6404
6405 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
6406 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
6407 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
6408 RTL expression.
6409
6410 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
6411 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
6412 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
6413 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
6414 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
6415 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
6416 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
6417
6418 @findex reg_names
6419 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
6420 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
6421 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
6422 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
6423
6424 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
6425 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
6426 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
6427 @var{code}.
6428 @end defmac
6429
6430 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
6431 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
6432 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
6433 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
6434 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
6435 in this way.
6436 @end defmac
6437
6438 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
6439 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
6440 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
6441 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
6442
6443 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
6444 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
6445 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
6446 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
6447 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
6448 Format}.
6449 @end defmac
6450
6451 @findex dbr_sequence_length
6452 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
6453 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
6454 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
6455 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
6456 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
6457 or whatever.
6458
6459 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
6460 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
6461 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
6462 @end defmac
6463
6464 @findex final_sequence
6465 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
6466 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
6467 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
6468 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
6469 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
6470 being output.
6471
6472 @findex asm_fprintf
6473 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
6474 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
6475 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
6476 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
6477 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
6478 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
6479 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
6480 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
6481 files can define these macros differently.
6482 @end defmac
6483
6484 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
6485 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
6486 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
6487 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
6488 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
6489 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
6490 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
6491 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
6492 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
6493 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
6494 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
6495 @end defmac
6496
6497 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
6498 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
6499 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
6500 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
6501 first variant.
6502
6503 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
6504 @smallexample
6505 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
6506 @end smallexample
6507 @noindent
6508 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
6509 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
6510 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
6511 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
6512 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
6513 alternatives within the braces than the value of
6514 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing. If it's needed
6515 to print curly braces or @samp{|} character in assembler output directly,
6516 @samp{%@{}, @samp{%@}} and @samp{%|} can be used.
6517
6518 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
6519 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
6520 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
6521
6522 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
6523 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
6524 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
6525 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
6526 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
6527 opcodes or operand order.
6528 @end defmac
6529
6530 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
6531 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
6532 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
6533 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
6534 profiling.
6535 @end defmac
6536
6537 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
6538 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
6539 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
6540 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
6541 profiling.
6542 @end defmac
6543
6544 @node Dispatch Tables
6545 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
6546
6547 @c prevent bad page break with this line
6548 This concerns dispatch tables.
6549
6550 @cindex dispatch table
6551 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
6552 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
6553 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
6554 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
6555 definitions of these labels are output using
6556 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
6557 way here. For example,
6558
6559 @smallexample
6560 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
6561 @var{value}, @var{rel})
6562 @end smallexample
6563
6564 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
6565 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
6566 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
6567 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
6568 mode and flags can be read.
6569 @end defmac
6570
6571 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
6572 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
6573 in a dispatch table are absolute.
6574
6575 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
6576 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
6577 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
6578 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
6579 For example,
6580
6581 @smallexample
6582 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
6583 @end smallexample
6584 @end defmac
6585
6586 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
6587 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
6588 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
6589 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
6590 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_table_data} containing an
6591 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
6592
6593 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
6594 for the table.
6595
6596 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
6597 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
6598 @end defmac
6599
6600 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
6601 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
6602 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
6603 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
6604 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
6605 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
6606 of the preceding label.
6607
6608 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
6609 the jump-table.
6610 @end defmac
6611
6612 @hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL
6613
6614 @hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL
6615
6616 @hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY
6617
6618 @hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT
6619
6620 @hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
6621
6622 @node Exception Region Output
6623 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
6624
6625 @c prevent bad page break with this line
6626
6627 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
6628 region.
6629
6630 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
6631 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
6632 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
6633 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6634 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
6635
6636 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
6637 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
6638 @end defmac
6639
6640 @defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
6641 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
6642 data section even though the target supports named sections. This
6643 might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
6644 collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
6645
6646 Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
6647 also defined.
6648 @end defmac
6649
6650 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
6651 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
6652 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
6653 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
6654 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
6655 @end defmac
6656
6657 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
6658 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
6659 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
6660 @end defmac
6661
6662 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
6663 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
6664 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
6665 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
6666 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
6667 GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
6668 @end defmac
6669
6670 @hook TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO
6671 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
6672 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
6673 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
6674 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
6675 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
6676 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
6677
6678 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
6679 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
6680 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
6681
6682 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
6683 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
6684 @var{opts}. In particular, the
6685 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
6686 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
6687 depending on this setting.
6688
6689 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
6690 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
6691 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
6692 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
6693 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
6694 @end deftypefn
6695
6696 @hook TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
6697 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
6698 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
6699 command-line option processing.
6700 @end deftypevr
6701
6702 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
6703 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
6704 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
6705 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
6706 @end defmac
6707
6708 @defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
6709 This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
6710 defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
6711 for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
6712 is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
6713 The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
6714 @end defmac
6715
6716 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
6717 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
6718 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
6719 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
6720 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
6721 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
6722 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
6723 @end defmac
6724
6725 @hook TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
6726
6727 @hook TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN
6728
6729 @hook TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA
6730
6731 @hook TARGET_ASM_TTYPE
6732
6733 @hook TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
6734
6735 @node Alignment Output
6736 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
6737
6738 @c prevent bad page break with this line
6739 This describes commands for alignment.
6740
6741 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
6742 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
6743 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
6744
6745 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
6746 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
6747 define the macro.
6748
6749 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
6750 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
6751 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
6752 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
6753 @end defmac
6754
6755 @hook TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
6756
6757 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
6758 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
6759 a @code{BARRIER}.
6760
6761 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
6762 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
6763 define the macro.
6764 @end defmac
6765
6766 @hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
6767
6768 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
6769 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label} that heads
6770 a frequently executed basic block (usually the header of a loop).
6771
6772 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
6773 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
6774 define the macro.
6775
6776 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
6777 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
6778 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
6779 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
6780 @end defmac
6781
6782 @hook TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
6783
6784 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
6785 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
6786 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
6787 the maximum of the specified values is used.
6788
6789 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
6790 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
6791 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
6792 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
6793 @end defmac
6794
6795 @hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
6796
6797 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
6798 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
6799 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
6800 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
6801 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
6802 @end defmac
6803
6804 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
6805 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
6806 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
6807 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
6808 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
6809 section.
6810 @end defmac
6811
6812 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
6813 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
6814 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
6815 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
6816 @end defmac
6817
6818 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
6819 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
6820 for padding, if necessary.
6821 @end defmac
6822
6823 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
6824 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
6825 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
6826 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
6827 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
6828 a C expression of type @code{int}.
6829 @end defmac
6830
6831 @need 3000
6832 @node Debugging Info
6833 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
6834
6835 @c prevent bad page break with this line
6836 This describes how to specify debugging information.
6837
6838 @menu
6839 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
6840 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
6841 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
6842 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
6843 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
6844 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
6845 @end menu
6846
6847 @node All Debuggers
6848 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
6849
6850 @c prevent bad page break with this line
6851 These macros affect all debugging formats.
6852
6853 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
6854 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
6855 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
6856 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
6857 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
6858 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
6859 compiler and another for DBX@.
6860
6861 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
6862 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
6863 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
6864 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
6865 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
6866
6867 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
6868 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
6869 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
6870 @end defmac
6871
6872 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
6873 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
6874 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
6875 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
6876 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
6877 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
6878 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
6879 @option{-g} options is used.
6880 @end defmac
6881
6882 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
6883 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
6884 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
6885 @var{offset}.
6886 @end defmac
6887
6888 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
6889 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
6890 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
6891 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
6892 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
6893 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
6894 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
6895
6896 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
6897 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
6898 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
6899 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
6900 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
6901
6902 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
6903 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
6904 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
6905 @end defmac
6906
6907 @node DBX Options
6908 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
6909
6910 @c prevent bad page break with this line
6911 These are specific options for DBX output.
6912
6913 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
6914 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
6915 in response to the @option{-g} option.
6916 @end defmac
6917
6918 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
6919 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
6920 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
6921 @end defmac
6922
6923 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
6924 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
6925 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
6926 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
6927 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
6928 if there is any occasion to.
6929 @end defmac
6930
6931 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
6932 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
6933 in the text section.
6934 @end defmac
6935
6936 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
6937 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
6938 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
6939 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
6940 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
6941 @end defmac
6942
6943 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
6944 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
6945 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
6946 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
6947 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
6948 information format.
6949 @end defmac
6950
6951 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
6952 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
6953 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
6954 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
6955 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
6956 @end defmac
6957
6958 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
6959 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
6960 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
6961 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
6962 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
6963 @end defmac
6964
6965 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
6966 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
6967 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
6968 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
6969 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
6970 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
6971 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
6972 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
6973 @end defmac
6974
6975 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
6976 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
6977 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
6978 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
6979 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
6980 if backslash is correct for your system.
6981 @end defmac
6982
6983 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
6984 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
6985 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
6986 variable.
6987 @end defmac
6988
6989 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
6990 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
6991 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
6992 @end defmac
6993
6994 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
6995 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
6996 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
6997 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
6998 @end defmac
6999
7000 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
7001 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7002 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
7003 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
7004 @end defmac
7005
7006 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
7007 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
7008 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
7009 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
7010 @end defmac
7011
7012 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
7013 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
7014 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
7015 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
7016 code.
7017 @end defmac
7018
7019 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
7020 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
7021 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
7022 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
7023 an absolute address.
7024 @end defmac
7025
7026 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
7027 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
7028 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
7029 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
7030 @end defmac
7031
7032 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
7033 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
7034 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
7035 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
7036 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
7037 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
7038 number for a type number.
7039 @end defmac
7040
7041 @node DBX Hooks
7042 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
7043
7044 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7045 These are hooks for DBX format.
7046
7047 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
7048 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
7049 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
7050 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
7051 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
7052 unique labels in the assembly output.
7053
7054 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
7055 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
7056 @end defmac
7057
7058 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
7059 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
7060 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
7061 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
7062 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
7063 @end defmac
7064
7065 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
7066 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
7067 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
7068 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
7069 @end defmac
7070
7071 @node File Names and DBX
7072 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
7073
7074 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7075 This describes file names in DBX format.
7076
7077 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7078 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
7079 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
7080 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
7081 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
7082
7083 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7084 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
7085
7086 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
7087 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
7088 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
7089 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
7090 @end defmac
7091
7092 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
7093 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
7094 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
7095 the beginning of the file.
7096 @end defmac
7097
7098 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
7099 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
7100 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
7101 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
7102 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
7103 @end defmac
7104
7105 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7106 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
7107 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
7108 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7109
7110 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
7111 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
7112 @end defmac
7113
7114 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
7115 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
7116 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
7117 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
7118 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
7119 @end defmac
7120
7121 @need 2000
7122 @node SDB and DWARF
7123 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
7124
7125 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7126 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
7127
7128 @defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
7129 Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
7130 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
7131 @end defmac
7132
7133 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
7134 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
7135 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
7136
7137 @hook TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION
7138
7139 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
7140 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
7141 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
7142 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
7143 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
7144 @end defmac
7145
7146 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
7147 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
7148 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
7149 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
7150 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
7151 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
7152 @end defmac
7153
7154 @hook TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO
7155
7156 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
7157 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
7158 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
7159 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
7160 @end defmac
7161
7162 @hook TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
7163
7164 @hook TARGET_FORCE_AT_COMP_DIR
7165
7166 @hook TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
7167
7168 @hook TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
7169
7170 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
7171 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
7172 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
7173 @end defmac
7174
7175 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
7176 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
7177 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
7178 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
7179 @end defmac
7180
7181 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
7182 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
7183 section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
7184 given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
7185 @end defmac
7186
7187 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
7188 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
7189 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
7190 @end defmac
7191
7192 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
7193 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
7194 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
7195 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
7196 is referenced by a function.
7197 @end defmac
7198
7199 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
7200
7201 @defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
7202 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
7203 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
7204 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
7205 not define them yourself.
7206 @end defmac
7207
7208 @defmac SDB_DELIM
7209 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
7210 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
7211 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
7212 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
7213 required.
7214 @end defmac
7215
7216 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
7217 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
7218 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
7219 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
7220 it.
7221 @end defmac
7222
7223 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
7224 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
7225 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
7226 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
7227 @end defmac
7228
7229 @defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
7230 A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
7231 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
7232 @var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
7233 @end defmac
7234
7235 @need 2000
7236 @node VMS Debug
7237 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
7238
7239 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7240 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
7241
7242 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
7243 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
7244 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
7245 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
7246 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
7247 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
7248 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
7249 @end defmac
7250
7251 @node Floating Point
7252 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
7253 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
7254 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
7255
7256 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
7257 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
7258 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
7259 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
7260 doing the compilation.
7261
7262 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
7263 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
7264 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
7265 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
7266 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
7267 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
7268 target floating point formats are identical.
7269
7270 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
7271 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
7272 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
7273 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
7274
7275 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
7276 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
7277 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
7278 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
7279 quantity.
7280 @end defmac
7281
7282 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
7283 Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
7284 floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
7285 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
7286 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
7287 @end deftypefn
7288
7289 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
7290 Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
7291 @end deftypefn
7292
7293 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
7294 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
7295 @end deftypefn
7296
7297 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
7298 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
7299 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
7300 @end deftypefn
7301
7302 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
7303 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
7304 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
7305 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
7306 defined by the C language for both.
7307 @end deftypefn
7308
7309 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
7310 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
7311 @end deftypefn
7312
7313 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
7314 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
7315 @end deftypefn
7316
7317 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
7318 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
7319 @end deftypefn
7320
7321 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
7322 Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
7323 @var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
7324 variable).
7325
7326 The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
7327 following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
7328 @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
7329
7330 If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
7331 target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
7332 @code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
7333 @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
7334 @end deftypefn
7335
7336 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
7337 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
7338 @end deftypefn
7339
7340 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
7341 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
7342 @end deftypefn
7343
7344 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
7345 Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{val},
7346 into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
7347 value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
7348 @end deftypefn
7349
7350 @node Mode Switching
7351 @section Mode Switching Instructions
7352 @cindex mode switching
7353 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
7354
7355 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
7356 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
7357 switching in an optimizing compilation.
7358
7359 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
7360 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
7361 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
7362 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
7363 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
7364 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
7365 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
7366
7367 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
7368 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
7369 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
7370 If you define this macro, you also have to define
7371 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
7372 @code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
7373 @code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
7374 are optional.
7375 @end defmac
7376
7377 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
7378 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
7379 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
7380 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
7381 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
7382 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
7383 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
7384 entity in question.
7385 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
7386 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
7387 switch is needed / supplied.
7388 @end defmac
7389
7390 @defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
7391 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
7392 @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
7393 return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
7394 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
7395 be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
7396 @end defmac
7397
7398 @defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{insn})
7399 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
7400 this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
7401 mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
7402 different from the incoming mode).
7403 @end defmac
7404
7405 @defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
7406 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
7407 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
7408 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
7409 is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
7410 @end defmac
7411
7412 @defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
7413 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
7414 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
7415 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
7416 is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
7417 @end defmac
7418
7419 @defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
7420 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
7421 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
7422 lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
7423 for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
7424 (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
7425 @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
7426 @end defmac
7427
7428 @defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
7429 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
7430 @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
7431 the insn(s) are to be inserted.
7432 @end defmac
7433
7434 @node Target Attributes
7435 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
7436 @cindex target attributes
7437 @cindex machine attributes
7438 @cindex attributes, target-specific
7439
7440 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
7441 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
7442 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
7443
7444 @hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
7445
7446 @hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P
7447
7448 @hook TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
7449
7450 @hook TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
7451
7452 @hook TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
7453
7454 @hook TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
7455
7456 @hook TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P
7457
7458 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
7459 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
7460 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
7461 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
7462 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
7463 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
7464 on this implementation detail.
7465 @end defmac
7466
7467 @hook TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES
7468
7469 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P
7470
7471 @hook TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P
7472
7473 @hook TARGET_OPTION_SAVE
7474
7475 @hook TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE
7476
7477 @hook TARGET_OPTION_PRINT
7478
7479 @hook TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE
7480
7481 @hook TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
7482
7483 @hook TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS
7484
7485 @hook TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P
7486
7487 @node Emulated TLS
7488 @section Emulating TLS
7489 @cindex Emulated TLS
7490
7491 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
7492 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
7493 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
7494 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
7495 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
7496 layer.
7497
7498 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
7499 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
7500 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
7501 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
7502
7503 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
7504
7505 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
7506
7507 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
7508
7509 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
7510
7511 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
7512
7513 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
7514
7515 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS
7516
7517 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT
7518
7519 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
7520
7521 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
7522
7523 @node MIPS Coprocessors
7524 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
7525 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
7526
7527 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
7528 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
7529 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
7530 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
7531
7532 @smallexample
7533 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
7534 unsigned int d;
7535
7536 d = cp0count + 3;
7537 @end smallexample
7538
7539 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
7540 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
7541 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
7542
7543 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
7544 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
7545 later in the function.
7546
7547 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
7548 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
7549 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
7550
7551 There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
7552 you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
7553
7554 @node PCH Target
7555 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
7556 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
7557
7558 @hook TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY
7559
7560 @hook TARGET_PCH_VALID_P
7561
7562 @hook TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS
7563
7564 @hook TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE
7565
7566 @node C++ ABI
7567 @section C++ ABI parameters
7568 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
7569
7570 @hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE
7571
7572 @hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT
7573
7574 @hook TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE
7575
7576 @hook TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE
7577
7578 @hook TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS
7579
7580 @hook TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS
7581
7582 @hook TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE
7583
7584 @hook TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY
7585
7586 @hook TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT
7587
7588 @hook TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT
7589
7590 @hook TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT
7591
7592 @hook TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT
7593
7594 @hook TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION
7595
7596 @hook TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT
7597
7598 @node Named Address Spaces
7599 @section Adding support for named address spaces
7600 @cindex named address spaces
7601
7602 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
7603 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
7604 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
7605 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
7606 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
7607 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
7608 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
7609 @code{const} type attributes.
7610
7611 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
7612 pointers to the generic address space.
7613
7614 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
7615 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
7616 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
7617 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
7618 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
7619 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
7620 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
7621 always 32 bits).
7622
7623 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
7624 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
7625 address space.
7626
7627 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
7628 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
7629 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
7630 named address space #1:
7631 @smallexample
7632 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
7633 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
7634 @end smallexample
7635
7636 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE
7637
7638 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE
7639
7640 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE
7641
7642 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
7643
7644 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
7645
7646 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P
7647
7648 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT
7649
7650 @node Misc
7651 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
7652 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
7653
7654 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7655 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
7656
7657 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
7658 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
7659 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
7660 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
7661 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
7662 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
7663 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
7664 @end defmac
7665
7666 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
7667 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
7668 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
7669 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
7670 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
7671 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
7672 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
7673 @end defmac
7674
7675 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
7676 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
7677 elements of a jump-table should have.
7678 @end defmac
7679
7680 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
7681 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
7682 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
7683 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
7684 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
7685 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
7686 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
7687 flags can be updated.
7688 @end defmac
7689
7690 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
7691 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
7692 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
7693 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
7694 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
7695 is in effect.
7696 @end defmac
7697
7698 @hook TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
7699
7700 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
7701 Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
7702 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
7703 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
7704 @end defmac
7705
7706 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
7707 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
7708 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
7709 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
7710 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
7711 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
7712 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
7713 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
7714
7715 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
7716 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
7717 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
7718 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
7719 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
7720
7721 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
7722 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
7723 of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
7724 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
7725 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
7726
7727 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
7728 mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
7729 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
7730 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
7731 @end defmac
7732
7733 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
7734 Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
7735 extends.
7736 @end defmac
7737
7738 @hook TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL
7739
7740 @defmac MOVE_MAX
7741 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
7742 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
7743 @end defmac
7744
7745 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
7746 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
7747 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
7748 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
7749 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
7750 at run-time.
7751 @end defmac
7752
7753 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
7754 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
7755 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
7756 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
7757 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
7758 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
7759 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
7760 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
7761 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
7762 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
7763 arguments to bit-field instructions.
7764
7765 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
7766 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
7767 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
7768
7769 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
7770 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
7771 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
7772 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
7773 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
7774
7775 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
7776 @end defmac
7777
7778 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
7779 @hook TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK
7780
7781 @defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
7782 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
7783 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
7784 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
7785 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
7786
7787 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
7788
7789 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
7790 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7791 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
7792 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
7793 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
7794 such cases may improve things.
7795 @end defmac
7796
7797 @hook TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED
7798
7799 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
7800 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
7801 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
7802 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
7803 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
7804 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
7805
7806 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
7807 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
7808 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
7809 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
7810 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
7811 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
7812 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
7813 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
7814 the compiler.
7815
7816 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
7817 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
7818 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
7819 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
7820 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
7821 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
7822 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
7823 expression
7824
7825 @smallexample
7826 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
7827 @end smallexample
7828
7829 @noindent
7830 can be converted to
7831
7832 @smallexample
7833 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
7834 @end smallexample
7835
7836 @noindent
7837 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
7838 tested into the sign bit.
7839
7840 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
7841 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
7842 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
7843 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
7844 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
7845 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
7846
7847 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
7848 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
7849 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
7850 to be used:
7851
7852 @itemize @bullet
7853 @item
7854 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
7855 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
7856 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
7857 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
7858 combine the normalization with other operations.
7859
7860 @item
7861 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
7862 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
7863 other machines.
7864
7865 @item
7866 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
7867 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
7868 others.
7869
7870 @item
7871 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
7872 @end itemize
7873
7874 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
7875 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
7876 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
7877 those cases, e.g., one matching
7878
7879 @smallexample
7880 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
7881 @end smallexample
7882
7883 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
7884 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
7885 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
7886 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
7887 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
7888 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
7889 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
7890 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
7891
7892 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
7893 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
7894 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
7895 @end defmac
7896
7897 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
7898 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
7899 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
7900 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
7901 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
7902 this macro.
7903 @end defmac
7904
7905 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
7906 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
7907 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
7908 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
7909 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
7910 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
7911 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
7912 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
7913 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
7914 given mode.
7915 @end defmac
7916
7917 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
7918 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
7919 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
7920 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
7921 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
7922 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
7923 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
7924 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
7925 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
7926 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
7927 this value.
7928
7929 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
7930 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
7931
7932 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
7933 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
7934 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
7935 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
7936
7937 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
7938 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
7939 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
7940 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
7941 breaking the API@.
7942 @end defmac
7943
7944 @defmac Pmode
7945 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
7946 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
7947 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
7948 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
7949 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
7950
7951 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
7952 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
7953 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
7954 to @code{Pmode}.
7955 @end defmac
7956
7957 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
7958 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
7959 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
7960 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
7961 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
7962 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
7963 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
7964 @end defmac
7965
7966 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
7967 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
7968 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
7969 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
7970 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
7971 strict conformance to the C Standard.
7972
7973 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
7974 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
7975 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
7976 @end defmac
7977
7978 @hook TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE
7979
7980 @hook TARGET_CXX_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
7981
7982 @defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
7983 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
7984 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
7985 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
7986 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
7987 @end defmac
7988
7989 @findex #pragma
7990 @findex pragma
7991 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
7992 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
7993 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
7994 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
7995 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
7996 setup required for the pragmas.
7997
7998 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
7999 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
8000 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
8001
8002 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
8003 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
8004
8005 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
8006 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
8007 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
8008 @end defmac
8009
8010 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
8011 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
8012
8013 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
8014 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
8015 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
8016 pragma of the form
8017
8018 @smallexample
8019 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
8020 @end smallexample
8021
8022 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
8023 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
8024 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
8025 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
8026 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
8027 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
8028 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
8029 arguments of pragmas registered with
8030 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
8031 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
8032
8033 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
8034 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
8035 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
8036 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
8037 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
8038 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
8039 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
8040 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
8041 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
8042 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
8043 how to build this object file.
8044 @end deftypefun
8045
8046 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
8047 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
8048 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
8049 @end defmac
8050
8051 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
8052 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
8053 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
8054 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
8055 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
8056 @end defmac
8057
8058 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
8059 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
8060 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
8061 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
8062 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
8063 @end defmac
8064
8065 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
8066 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
8067 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
8068 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
8069 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
8070 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
8071 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
8072 you should define this macro.
8073
8074 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
8075 @end defmac
8076
8077 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
8078 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
8079 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
8080 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
8081 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
8082 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
8083 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
8084 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
8085 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
8086 slot of @var{insn}.
8087
8088 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
8089 @end defmac
8090
8091 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
8092 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
8093 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
8094 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
8095 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
8096 from shared libraries (DLLs).
8097
8098 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
8099 @end defmac
8100
8101 @hook TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
8102
8103 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
8104 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
8105 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
8106 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
8107 separate math library.
8108
8109 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
8110 @end defmac
8111
8112 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
8113 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
8114 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
8115
8116 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
8117 is wrong.
8118 @end defmac
8119
8120 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
8121 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
8122 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
8123 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
8124 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
8125 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
8126 for cross-profiling.
8127 @end defmac
8128
8129 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
8130
8131 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
8132 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
8133 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
8134 1 if it does use cc0.
8135 @end defmac
8136
8137 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
8138 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
8139 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
8140 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
8141 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
8142 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
8143 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
8144 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
8145 @end defmac
8146
8147 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
8148 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
8149 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
8150 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
8151 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
8152 @end defmac
8153
8154 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
8155 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
8156 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
8157 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
8158 about the currently processed blocks.
8159 @end defmac
8160
8161 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
8162 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
8163 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
8164 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
8165 to by @var{ce_info}.
8166 @end defmac
8167
8168 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
8169 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
8170 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
8171 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
8172 to by @var{ce_info}.
8173 @end defmac
8174
8175 @defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
8176 A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
8177 of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
8178 to by @var{ce_info}.
8179 @end defmac
8180
8181 @hook TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
8182
8183 @hook TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
8184
8185 @hook TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL
8186
8187 @hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
8188
8189 @hook TARGET_BUILTIN_CHKP_FUNCTION
8190 @hook TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_TYPE
8191 @hook TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_MODE
8192
8193 @hook TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN
8194
8195 @hook TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN
8196
8197 @hook TARGET_GIMPLE_FOLD_BUILTIN
8198
8199 @hook TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY
8200
8201 @hook TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER
8202
8203 @hook TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY
8204
8205 @hook TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP
8206
8207 @hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN
8208
8209 @defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
8210
8211 Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
8212 Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
8213 @var{branch2} is possible.
8214
8215 On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
8216 filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
8217 may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
8218 @end defmac
8219
8220 @hook TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP
8221
8222 @hook TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P
8223
8224 @hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
8225
8226 @hook TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P
8227
8228 @hook TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION
8229
8230 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
8231 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
8232 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
8233 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
8234 @end defmac
8235
8236 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
8237 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
8238 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
8239 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
8240 executable files.
8241 @end defmac
8242
8243 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
8244 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
8245 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
8246 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
8247 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
8248 lists.
8249 @end defmac
8250
8251 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
8252 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
8253 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
8254 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
8255 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
8256 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
8257 defined as this expression:
8258
8259 @smallexample
8260 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
8261 build_tree_list
8262 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
8263 NULL))
8264 @end smallexample
8265 @end defmac
8266
8267 @hook TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P
8268
8269 @hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS
8270
8271 @hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED
8272
8273 @hook TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION
8274
8275 @hook TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST
8276
8277 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
8278 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
8279 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
8280 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
8281 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
8282 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
8283 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
8284 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
8285 @end defmac
8286
8287 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
8288 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
8289 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
8290 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
8291 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
8292 @end deftypefn
8293
8294 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
8295 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
8296 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
8297 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
8298 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
8299 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
8300 @end deftypefn
8301
8302 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
8303 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
8304 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
8305 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
8306 that are different from @option{-I}.
8307 @end deftypefn
8308
8309 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
8310 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
8311 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
8312 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
8313 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
8314 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
8315 @end defmac
8316
8317 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
8318 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
8319 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
8320 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
8321 @end defmac
8322
8323 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
8324 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
8325 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
8326 @end defmac
8327
8328 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
8329 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
8330 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
8331 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
8332 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
8333 @end defmac
8334
8335 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
8336 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
8337 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
8338 @end defmac
8339
8340 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
8341 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
8342 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
8343 and scanf formatter settings.
8344 @end defmac
8345
8346 @hook TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
8347
8348 @hook TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN
8349
8350 @hook TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION
8351
8352 @hook TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP
8353
8354 @hook TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP
8355
8356 @hook TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE
8357
8358 @hook TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE
8359
8360 @hook TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE
8361
8362 @hook TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE
8363
8364 @defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
8365 This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
8366 classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
8367 SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
8368 @end defmac
8369
8370 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
8371 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
8372 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
8373 @end defmac
8374
8375 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
8376 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
8377 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
8378 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
8379 and the associated definitions of those functions.
8380 @end defmac
8381
8382 @hook TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY
8383
8384 @hook TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX
8385
8386 @hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS
8387
8388 @hook TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
8389
8390 @hook TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET
8391
8392 @hook TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK
8393
8394 @hook TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
8395
8396 @hook TARGET_HAS_IFUNC_P
8397
8398 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT
8399
8400 On older ports, large integers are stored in @code{CONST_DOUBLE} rtl
8401 objects. Newer ports define @code{TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT} to be non
8402 zero to indicate that large integers are stored in
8403 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} rtl objects. The @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} allows
8404 very large integer constants to be represented. @code{CONST_DOUBLE}
8405 are limited to twice the size of host's @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}
8406 representation.
8407
8408 Converting a port mostly requires looking for the places where
8409 @code{CONST_DOUBLES} are used with @code{VOIDmode} and replacing that
8410 code with code that accesses @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. @samp{"grep -i
8411 const_double"} at the port level gets you to 95% of the changes that
8412 need to be made. There are a few places that require a deeper look.
8413
8414 @itemize @bullet
8415 @item
8416 There is no equivalent to @code{hval} and @code{lval} for
8417 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. This would be difficult to express in the md
8418 language since there are a variable number of elements.
8419
8420 Most ports only check that @code{hval} is either 0 or -1 to see if the
8421 value is small. As mentioned above, this will no longer be necessary
8422 since small constants are always @code{CONST_INT}. Of course there
8423 are still a few exceptions, the alpha's constraint used by the zap
8424 instruction certainly requires careful examination by C code.
8425 However, all the current code does is pass the hval and lval to C
8426 code, so evolving the c code to look at the @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} is
8427 not really a large change.
8428
8429 @item
8430 Because there is no standard template that ports use to materialize
8431 constants, there is likely to be some futzing that is unique to each
8432 port in this code.
8433
8434 @item
8435 The rtx costs may have to be adjusted to properly account for larger
8436 constants that are represented as @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}.
8437 @end itemize
8438
8439 All and all it does not takes long to convert ports that the
8440 maintainer is familiar with.
8441
8442 @end defmac
8443